From c1a1b6eeecb375259968ef6d989833312047f2d8 Mon Sep 17 00:00:00 2001
From: Dean Camera <dean@fourwalledcubicle.com>
Date: Mon, 23 Feb 2009 07:08:15 +0000
Subject: [PATCH] Moved all source to the trunk directory.

---
 Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.aps       |    1 +
 Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.c         |  570 +++++++++
 Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.h         |  135 +++
 Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.txt       |   40 +
 Bootloaders/CDC/Descriptors.c           |  247 ++++
 Bootloaders/CDC/Descriptors.h           |   95 ++
 Bootloaders/CDC/Doxygen.conf            | 1485 +++++++++++++++++++++++
 Bootloaders/CDC/LUFA CDC Bootloader.inf |   55 +
 Bootloaders/CDC/makefile                |  711 +++++++++++
 Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.aps       |    1 +
 Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.c         |  692 +++++++++++
 Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.h         |  199 +++
 Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.txt       |   52 +
 Bootloaders/DFU/Descriptors.c           |  181 +++
 Bootloaders/DFU/Descriptors.h           |  166 +++
 Bootloaders/DFU/Doxygen.conf            | 1485 +++++++++++++++++++++++
 Bootloaders/DFU/makefile                |  714 +++++++++++
 Bootloaders/TeensyHID/Descriptors.c     |  218 ++++
 Bootloaders/TeensyHID/Descriptors.h     |   91 ++
 Bootloaders/TeensyHID/Doxygen.conf      | 1485 +++++++++++++++++++++++
 Bootloaders/TeensyHID/TeensyHID.c       |  156 +++
 Bootloaders/TeensyHID/TeensyHID.h       |   73 ++
 Bootloaders/TeensyHID/TeensyHID.txt     |   41 +
 Bootloaders/TeensyHID/makefile          |  711 +++++++++++
 Bootloaders/makefile                    |   29 +
 25 files changed, 9633 insertions(+)
 create mode 100644 Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.aps
 create mode 100644 Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.c
 create mode 100644 Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.h
 create mode 100644 Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.txt
 create mode 100644 Bootloaders/CDC/Descriptors.c
 create mode 100644 Bootloaders/CDC/Descriptors.h
 create mode 100644 Bootloaders/CDC/Doxygen.conf
 create mode 100644 Bootloaders/CDC/LUFA CDC Bootloader.inf
 create mode 100644 Bootloaders/CDC/makefile
 create mode 100644 Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.aps
 create mode 100644 Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.c
 create mode 100644 Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.h
 create mode 100644 Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.txt
 create mode 100644 Bootloaders/DFU/Descriptors.c
 create mode 100644 Bootloaders/DFU/Descriptors.h
 create mode 100644 Bootloaders/DFU/Doxygen.conf
 create mode 100644 Bootloaders/DFU/makefile
 create mode 100644 Bootloaders/TeensyHID/Descriptors.c
 create mode 100644 Bootloaders/TeensyHID/Descriptors.h
 create mode 100644 Bootloaders/TeensyHID/Doxygen.conf
 create mode 100644 Bootloaders/TeensyHID/TeensyHID.c
 create mode 100644 Bootloaders/TeensyHID/TeensyHID.h
 create mode 100644 Bootloaders/TeensyHID/TeensyHID.txt
 create mode 100644 Bootloaders/TeensyHID/makefile
 create mode 100644 Bootloaders/makefile

diff --git a/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.aps b/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.aps
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..a0f0e7563
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.aps
@@ -0,0 +1 @@
+<AVRStudio><MANAGEMENT><ProjectName>BootloaderCDC</ProjectName><Created>30-Sep-2008 14:20:09</Created><LastEdit>30-Sep-2008 14:20:30</LastEdit><ICON>241</ICON><ProjectType>0</ProjectType><Created>30-Sep-2008 14:20:09</Created><Version>4</Version><Build>4, 14, 0, 589</Build><ProjectTypeName>AVR GCC</ProjectTypeName></MANAGEMENT><CODE_CREATION><ObjectFile>BootloaderCDC.elf</ObjectFile><EntryFile></EntryFile><SaveFolder>C:\Users\Dean\Documents\Electronics\Projects\WORK\MyUSBWORK\Bootloaders\CDC\</SaveFolder></CODE_CREATION><DEBUG_TARGET><CURRENT_TARGET></CURRENT_TARGET><CURRENT_PART></CURRENT_PART><BREAKPOINTS></BREAKPOINTS><IO_EXPAND><HIDE>false</HIDE></IO_EXPAND><REGISTERNAMES><Register>R00</Register><Register>R01</Register><Register>R02</Register><Register>R03</Register><Register>R04</Register><Register>R05</Register><Register>R06</Register><Register>R07</Register><Register>R08</Register><Register>R09</Register><Register>R10</Register><Register>R11</Register><Register>R12</Register><Register>R13</Register><Register>R14</Register><Register>R15</Register><Register>R16</Register><Register>R17</Register><Register>R18</Register><Register>R19</Register><Register>R20</Register><Register>R21</Register><Register>R22</Register><Register>R23</Register><Register>R24</Register><Register>R25</Register><Register>R26</Register><Register>R27</Register><Register>R28</Register><Register>R29</Register><Register>R30</Register><Register>R31</Register></REGISTERNAMES><COM>Auto</COM><COMType>0</COMType><WATCHNUM>0</WATCHNUM><WATCHNAMES><Pane0></Pane0><Pane1></Pane1><Pane2></Pane2><Pane3></Pane3></WATCHNAMES><BreakOnTrcaeFull>0</BreakOnTrcaeFull></DEBUG_TARGET><Debugger><Triggers></Triggers></Debugger><AVRGCCPLUGIN><FILES><SOURCEFILE>BootloaderCDC.c</SOURCEFILE><SOURCEFILE>Descriptors.c</SOURCEFILE><HEADERFILE>BootloaderCDC.h</HEADERFILE><HEADERFILE>Descriptors.h</HEADERFILE><OTHERFILE>makefile</OTHERFILE></FILES><CONFIGS><CONFIG><NAME>default</NAME><USESEXTERNALMAKEFILE>YES</USESEXTERNALMAKEFILE><EXTERNALMAKEFILE>makefile</EXTERNALMAKEFILE><PART>atmega128</PART><HEX>1</HEX><LIST>1</LIST><MAP>1</MAP><OUTPUTFILENAME>BootloaderCDC.elf</OUTPUTFILENAME><OUTPUTDIR>default\</OUTPUTDIR><ISDIRTY>1</ISDIRTY><OPTIONS/><INCDIRS/><LIBDIRS/><LIBS/><LINKOBJECTS/><OPTIONSFORALL>-Wall -gdwarf-2 -std=gnu99 -Os -funsigned-char -funsigned-bitfields -fpack-struct -fshort-enums</OPTIONSFORALL><LINKEROPTIONS></LINKEROPTIONS><SEGMENTS/></CONFIG></CONFIGS><LASTCONFIG>default</LASTCONFIG><USES_WINAVR>1</USES_WINAVR><GCC_LOC>C:\WinAVR-20080512\bin\avr-gcc.exe</GCC_LOC><MAKE_LOC>C:\WinAVR-20080512\utils\bin\make.exe</MAKE_LOC></AVRGCCPLUGIN><ProjectFiles><Files><Name>C:\Users\Dean\Documents\Electronics\Projects\WORK\MyUSBWORK\Bootloaders\CDC\BootloaderCDC.h</Name><Name>C:\Users\Dean\Documents\Electronics\Projects\WORK\MyUSBWORK\Bootloaders\CDC\Descriptors.h</Name><Name>C:\Users\Dean\Documents\Electronics\Projects\WORK\MyUSBWORK\Bootloaders\CDC\BootloaderCDC.c</Name><Name>C:\Users\Dean\Documents\Electronics\Projects\WORK\MyUSBWORK\Bootloaders\CDC\Descriptors.c</Name></Files></ProjectFiles><IOView><usergroups/><sort sorted="0" column="0" ordername="0" orderaddress="0" ordergroup="0"/></IOView><Files></Files><Events><Bookmarks></Bookmarks></Events><Trace><Filters></Filters></Trace></AVRStudio>
diff --git a/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.c b/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.c
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..654eabd22
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.c
@@ -0,0 +1,570 @@
+/*
+             LUFA Library
+     Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2009.
+              
+  dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+      www.fourwalledcubicle.com
+*/
+
+/*
+  Copyright 2009  Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com)
+
+  Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software
+  and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby
+  granted, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all
+  copies and that both that the copyright notice and this
+  permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting
+  documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in
+  advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
+  software without specific, written prior permission.
+
+  The author disclaim all warranties with regard to this
+  software, including all implied warranties of merchantability
+  and fitness.  In no event shall the author be liable for any
+  special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages
+  whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether
+  in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action,
+  arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of
+  this software.
+*/
+
+/** \file
+ *
+ *  Main source file for the CDC class bootloader. This file contains the complete bootloader logic.
+ */
+ 
+#define  INCLUDE_FROM_BOOTLOADERCDC_C
+#include "BootloaderCDC.h"
+
+/* Globals: */
+/** Line coding options for the virtual serial port. Although the virtual serial port data is never
+ *  sent through a physical serial port, the line encoding data must still be read and preserved from
+ *  the host, or the host will detect a problem and fail to open the port. This structure contains the
+ *  current encoding options, including baud rate, character format, parity mode and total number of 
+ *  bits in each data chunk.
+ */
+CDC_Line_Coding_t LineCoding = { BaudRateBPS: 9600,
+                                 CharFormat:  OneStopBit,
+                                 ParityType:  Parity_None,
+                                 DataBits:    8            };
+
+/** Current address counter. This stores the current address of the FLASH or EEPROM as set by the host,
+ *  and is used when reading or writing to the AVRs memory (either FLASH or EEPROM depending on the issued
+ *  command.)
+ */
+uint16_t CurrAddress;
+
+/** Flag to indicate if the bootloader should be running, or should exit and allow the application code to run
+ *  via a soft reset. When cleared, the bootloader will abort, the USB interface will shut down and the application
+ *  jumped to via an indirect jump to location 0x0000.
+ */
+bool RunBootloader = true;
+
+
+/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the bootloader, then continuously 
+ *  runs the bootloader processing routine until instructed to soft-exit, or hard-reset via the watchdog to start
+ *  the loaded application code.
+ */
+int main(void)
+{
+	/* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */
+	MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF);
+	wdt_disable();
+
+	/* Disable Clock Division */
+	SetSystemClockPrescaler(0);
+	
+	/* Relocate the interrupt vector table to the bootloader section */
+	MCUCR = (1 << IVCE);
+	MCUCR = (1 << IVSEL);
+	
+	/* Initialize USB Subsystem */
+	USB_Init();
+
+	while (RunBootloader)
+	{
+		USB_USBTask();
+		CDC_Task();
+	}
+	
+	Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDC_TX_EPNUM);
+
+	/* Wait until any pending transmissions have completed before shutting down */
+	while (!(Endpoint_ReadWriteAllowed()));
+	
+	/* Shut down the USB subsystem */
+	USB_ShutDown();
+	
+	/* Relocate the interrupt vector table back to the application section */
+	MCUCR = (1 << IVCE);
+	MCUCR = 0;
+
+	/* Reset any used hardware ports back to their defaults */
+	PORTD = 0;
+	DDRD  = 0;
+	
+	#if defined(PORTE)
+	PORTE = 0;
+	DDRE  = 0;
+	#endif
+	
+	/* Re-enable RWW section */
+	boot_rww_enable();
+
+	/* Start the user application */
+	AppPtr_t AppStartPtr = (AppPtr_t)0x0000;
+	AppStartPtr();	
+}
+
+/** Event handler for the USB_Disconnect event. This indicates that the bootloader should exit and the user
+ *  application started.
+ */
+EVENT_HANDLER(USB_Disconnect)
+{
+	/* Upon disconnection, run user application */
+	RunBootloader = false;
+}
+
+/** Event handler for the USB_ConfigurationChanged event. This configures the device's endpoints ready
+ *  to relay data to and from the attached USB host.
+ */
+EVENT_HANDLER(USB_ConfigurationChanged)
+{
+	/* Setup CDC Notification, Rx and Tx Endpoints */
+	Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPNUM, EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT,
+		                       ENDPOINT_DIR_IN, CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE,
+	                           ENDPOINT_BANK_SINGLE);
+
+	Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(CDC_TX_EPNUM, EP_TYPE_BULK,
+		                       ENDPOINT_DIR_IN, CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE,
+	                           ENDPOINT_BANK_SINGLE);
+
+	Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(CDC_RX_EPNUM, EP_TYPE_BULK,
+		                       ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT, CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE,
+	                           ENDPOINT_BANK_SINGLE);
+}
+
+/** Event handler for the USB_UnhandledControlPacket event. This is used to catch standard and class specific
+ *  control requests that are not handled internally by the USB library, so that they can be handled appropriately
+ *  for the application.
+ */
+EVENT_HANDLER(USB_UnhandledControlPacket)
+{
+	uint8_t* LineCodingData = (uint8_t*)&LineCoding;
+
+	Endpoint_Discard_Word();
+
+	/* Process CDC specific control requests */
+	switch (bRequest)
+	{
+		case REQ_GetLineEncoding:
+			if (bmRequestType == (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE))
+			{
+				Endpoint_ClearSetupReceived();
+
+				for (uint8_t i = 0; i < sizeof(LineCoding); i++)
+				  Endpoint_Write_Byte(*(LineCodingData++));	
+				
+				Endpoint_ClearSetupIN();
+				
+				while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupOUTReceived()));
+				Endpoint_ClearSetupOUT();
+			}
+			
+			break;
+		case REQ_SetLineEncoding:
+			if (bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE))
+			{
+				Endpoint_ClearSetupReceived();
+
+				while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupOUTReceived()));
+
+				for (uint8_t i = 0; i < sizeof(LineCoding); i++)
+				  *(LineCodingData++) = Endpoint_Read_Byte();
+
+				Endpoint_ClearSetupOUT();
+
+				while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupINReady()));
+				Endpoint_ClearSetupIN();
+			}
+	
+			break;
+		case REQ_SetControlLineState:
+			if (bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE))
+			{
+				Endpoint_ClearSetupReceived();
+				
+				while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupINReady()));
+				Endpoint_ClearSetupIN();
+			}
+	
+			break;
+	}
+}
+
+/** Reads or writes a block of EEPROM or FLASH memory to or from the appropriate CDC data endpoint, depending
+ *  on the AVR910 protocol command issued.
+ *
+ *  \param Command  Single character AVR910 protocol command indicating what memory operation to perform
+ */
+static void ProgramReadWriteMemoryBlock(const uint8_t Command)
+{
+	uint16_t BlockSize;
+	char     MemoryType;
+	
+	bool     HighByte = false;
+	uint8_t  LowByte  = 0;
+	
+	BlockSize  = (FetchNextCommandByte() << 8);
+	BlockSize |=  FetchNextCommandByte();
+	
+	MemoryType =  FetchNextCommandByte();
+
+	if ((MemoryType == 'E') || (MemoryType == 'F'))
+	{
+		/* Check if command is to read memory */
+		if (Command == 'g')
+		{
+			/* Re-enable RWW section */
+			boot_rww_enable();
+
+			while (BlockSize--)
+			{
+				if (MemoryType == 'E')
+				{
+					/* Read the next EEPROM byte into the endpoint */
+					WriteNextResponseByte(eeprom_read_byte((uint8_t*)CurrAddress));
+
+					/* Increment the address counter after use */
+					CurrAddress++;
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					/* Read the next FLASH byte from the current FLASH page */
+					#if defined(RAMPZ)
+					WriteNextResponseByte(pgm_read_byte_far(((uint32_t)CurrAddress << 1) + HighByte));
+					#else
+					WriteNextResponseByte(pgm_read_byte((CurrAddress << 1) + HighByte));					
+					#endif
+					
+					/* If both bytes in current word have been read, increment the address counter */
+					if (HighByte)
+					  CurrAddress++;
+					
+					HighByte ^= 1;
+				}
+			}
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			uint32_t PageStartAddress = ((uint32_t)CurrAddress << 1);
+	
+			if (MemoryType == 'F')
+			{
+				boot_page_erase(PageStartAddress);
+				boot_spm_busy_wait();
+			}
+			
+			while (BlockSize--)
+			{
+				if (MemoryType == 'E')
+				{
+					/* Write the next EEPROM byte from the endpoint */
+					eeprom_write_byte((uint8_t*)CurrAddress, FetchNextCommandByte());					
+
+					/* Increment the address counter after use */
+					CurrAddress++;
+				}
+				else
+				{	
+					/* If both bytes in current word have been written, increment the address counter */
+					if (HighByte)
+					{
+						/* Write the next FLASH word to the current FLASH page */
+						boot_page_fill(((uint32_t)CurrAddress << 1), ((FetchNextCommandByte() << 8) | LowByte));
+
+						HighByte = false;
+						
+						/* Increment the address counter after use */
+						CurrAddress++;
+					}
+					else
+					{
+						LowByte = FetchNextCommandByte();
+					
+						HighByte = true;
+					}
+				}
+			}
+
+			/* If in FLASH programming mode, commit the page after writing */
+			if (MemoryType == 'F')
+			{
+				/* Commit the flash page to memory */
+				boot_page_write(PageStartAddress);
+				
+				/* Wait until write operation has completed */
+				boot_spm_busy_wait();
+			}
+		
+			/* Send response byte back to the host */
+			WriteNextResponseByte('\r');		
+		}
+	}
+	else
+	{
+		/* Send error byte back to the host */
+		WriteNextResponseByte('?');
+	}
+}
+
+/** Retrieves the next byte from the host in the CDC data OUT endpoint, and clears the endpoint bank if needed
+ *  to allow reception of the next data packet from the host.
+ *
+ *  \return Next received byte from the host in the CDC data OUT endpoint
+ */
+static uint8_t FetchNextCommandByte(void)
+{
+	/* Select the OUT endpoint so that the next data byte can be read */
+	Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDC_RX_EPNUM);
+	
+	/* If OUT endpoint empty, clear it and wait for the next packet from the host */
+	if (!(Endpoint_ReadWriteAllowed()))
+	{
+		Endpoint_ClearCurrentBank();
+		while (!(Endpoint_ReadWriteAllowed()));
+	}
+	
+	/* Fetch the next byte from the OUT endpoint */
+	return Endpoint_Read_Byte();
+}
+
+/** Writes the next response byte to the CDC data IN endpoint, and sends the endpoint back if needed to free up the
+ *  bank when full ready for the next byte in the packet to the host.
+ *
+ *  \param Response  Next response byte to send to the host
+ */
+static void WriteNextResponseByte(const uint8_t Response)
+{
+	/* Select the IN endpoint so that the next data byte can be written */
+	Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDC_TX_EPNUM);
+	
+	/* If OUT endpoint empty, clear it and wait for the next packet from the host */
+	if (!(Endpoint_ReadWriteAllowed()))
+	{
+		Endpoint_ClearCurrentBank();
+		while (!(Endpoint_ReadWriteAllowed()));
+	}
+	
+	/* Write the next byte to the OUT endpoint */
+	Endpoint_Write_Byte(Response);
+}
+
+/** Task to read in AVR910 commands from the CDC data OUT endpoint, process them, perform the required actions
+ *  and send the appropriate response back to the host.
+ */
+TASK(CDC_Task)
+{
+	/* Select the OUT endpoint */
+	Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDC_RX_EPNUM);
+	
+	/* Check if endpoint has a command in it sent from the host */
+	if (Endpoint_ReadWriteAllowed())
+	{
+		/* Read in the bootloader command (first byte sent from host) */
+		uint8_t Command = FetchNextCommandByte();
+
+		if ((Command == 'L') || (Command == 'P') || (Command == 'T') || (Command == 'E'))
+		{
+			if (Command == 'E')
+			  RunBootloader = false;
+			if (Command == 'T')
+			  FetchNextCommandByte();
+
+			/* Send confirmation byte back to the host */
+			WriteNextResponseByte('\r');			
+		}
+		else if (Command == 't')
+		{
+			/* Return ATMEGA128 part code - this is only to allow AVRProg to use the bootloader */
+			WriteNextResponseByte(0x44);
+
+			WriteNextResponseByte(0x00);
+		}
+		else if (Command == 'a')
+		{
+			/* Indicate auto-address increment is supported */
+			WriteNextResponseByte('Y');
+		}
+		else if (Command == 'A')
+		{
+			/* Set the current address to that given by the host */
+			CurrAddress  = (FetchNextCommandByte() << 8);
+			CurrAddress |=  FetchNextCommandByte();
+
+			/* Send confirmation byte back to the host */
+			WriteNextResponseByte('\r');
+		}
+		else if (Command == 'p')
+		{
+			/* Indicate serial programmer back to the host */
+			WriteNextResponseByte('S');		 
+		}
+		else if (Command == 'S')
+		{
+			/* Write the 7-byte software identifier to the endpoint */
+			for (uint8_t CurrByte = 0; CurrByte < 7; CurrByte++)
+			  WriteNextResponseByte(SOFTWARE_IDENTIFIER[CurrByte]);		
+		}
+		else if (Command == 'V')
+		{
+			WriteNextResponseByte('0' + BOOTLOADER_VERSION_MAJOR);
+			WriteNextResponseByte('0' + BOOTLOADER_VERSION_MINOR);
+		}
+		else if (Command == 's')
+		{
+			WriteNextResponseByte(boot_signature_byte_get(4));
+			WriteNextResponseByte(boot_signature_byte_get(2));
+			WriteNextResponseByte(boot_signature_byte_get(0));		
+		}
+		else if (Command == 'b')
+		{
+			WriteNextResponseByte('Y');
+				
+			/* Send block size to the host */
+			WriteNextResponseByte(SPM_PAGESIZE >> 8);
+			WriteNextResponseByte(SPM_PAGESIZE & 0xFF);		
+		}
+		else if (Command == 'e')
+		{
+			/* Clear the application section of flash */
+			for (uint32_t CurrFlashAddress = 0; CurrFlashAddress < BOOT_START_ADDR; CurrFlashAddress++)
+			{
+				boot_page_erase(CurrFlashAddress);
+				boot_spm_busy_wait();
+				boot_page_write(CurrFlashAddress);
+				boot_spm_busy_wait();
+
+				CurrFlashAddress += SPM_PAGESIZE;
+			}
+			
+			/* Send confirmation byte back to the host */
+			WriteNextResponseByte('\r');		
+		}
+		else if (Command == 'l')
+		{
+			/* Set the lock bits to those given by the host */
+			boot_lock_bits_set(FetchNextCommandByte());
+
+			/* Send confirmation byte back to the host */
+			WriteNextResponseByte('\r');
+		}
+		else if (Command == 'r')
+		{
+			WriteNextResponseByte(boot_lock_fuse_bits_get(GET_LOCK_BITS));		
+		}
+		else if (Command == 'F')
+		{
+			WriteNextResponseByte(boot_lock_fuse_bits_get(GET_LOW_FUSE_BITS));
+		}
+		else if (Command == 'N')
+		{
+			WriteNextResponseByte(boot_lock_fuse_bits_get(GET_HIGH_FUSE_BITS));		
+		}
+		else if (Command == 'Q')
+		{
+			WriteNextResponseByte(boot_lock_fuse_bits_get(GET_EXTENDED_FUSE_BITS));		
+		}
+		else if ((Command == 'C') || (Command == 'c'))
+		{
+			if (Command == 'c')
+			{
+				/* Increment the address if the second byte is being written */
+				CurrAddress++;
+			}
+			
+			/* Write the high byte to the current flash page */
+			boot_page_fill(((uint32_t)CurrAddress << 1), FetchNextCommandByte());
+			
+			/* Send confirmation byte back to the host */
+			WriteNextResponseByte('\r');		
+		}
+		else if (Command == 'm')
+		{
+			/* Commit the flash page to memory */
+			boot_page_write((uint32_t)CurrAddress << 1);
+			
+			/* Wait until write operation has completed */
+			boot_spm_busy_wait();
+
+			/* Send confirmation byte back to the host */
+			WriteNextResponseByte('\r');		
+		}
+		else if ((Command == 'B') || (Command == 'g'))
+		{
+			/* Delegate the block write/read to a seperate function for clarity */
+			ProgramReadWriteMemoryBlock(Command);
+		}
+		else if (Command == 'R')
+		{
+			#if defined(RAMPZ)
+			uint16_t ProgramWord = pgm_read_word_far(((uint32_t)CurrAddress << 1));
+			#else
+			uint16_t ProgramWord = pgm_read_word(CurrAddress << 1);			
+			#endif
+			
+			WriteNextResponseByte(ProgramWord >> 8);
+			WriteNextResponseByte(ProgramWord & 0xFF);
+		}
+		else if (Command == 'D')
+		{
+			/* Read the byte from the endpoint and write it to the EEPROM */
+			eeprom_write_byte((uint8_t*)CurrAddress, FetchNextCommandByte());
+			
+			/* Increment the address after use */			
+			CurrAddress++;
+	
+			/* Send confirmation byte back to the host */
+			WriteNextResponseByte('\r');		
+		}
+		else if (Command == 'd')
+		{
+			/* Read the EEPROM byte and write it to the endpoint */
+			WriteNextResponseByte(eeprom_read_byte((uint8_t*)CurrAddress));
+
+			/* Increment the address after use */
+			CurrAddress++;
+		}
+		else if (Command == 27)
+		{
+			/* Escape is sync, ignore */
+		}
+		else
+		{
+			/* Unknown command, return fail code */
+			WriteNextResponseByte('?');
+		}
+
+		/* Select the IN endpoint */
+		Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDC_TX_EPNUM);
+
+		/* Remember if the endpoint is completely full before clearing it */
+		bool IsEndpointFull = !(Endpoint_ReadWriteAllowed());
+
+		/* Send the endpoint data to the host */
+		Endpoint_ClearCurrentBank();
+		
+		/* If a full endpoint's worth of data was sent, we need to send an empty packet afterwards to signal end of transfer */
+		if (IsEndpointFull)
+		{
+			while (!(Endpoint_ReadWriteAllowed()));
+			Endpoint_ClearCurrentBank();
+		}
+		
+		/* Select the OUT endpoint */
+		Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDC_RX_EPNUM);
+
+		/* Acknowledge the command from the host */
+		Endpoint_ClearCurrentBank();
+	}
+}
diff --git a/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.h b/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.h
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..0d8f1e3d8
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.h
@@ -0,0 +1,135 @@
+/*
+             LUFA Library
+     Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2009.
+              
+  dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+      www.fourwalledcubicle.com
+*/
+
+/*
+  Copyright 2009  Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com)
+
+  Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software
+  and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby
+  granted, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all
+  copies and that both that the copyright notice and this
+  permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting
+  documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in
+  advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
+  software without specific, written prior permission.
+
+  The author disclaim all warranties with regard to this
+  software, including all implied warranties of merchantability
+  and fitness.  In no event shall the author be liable for any
+  special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages
+  whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether
+  in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action,
+  arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of
+  this software.
+*/
+
+/** \file
+ *
+ *  Header file for BootloaderCDC.c.
+ */
+ 
+#ifndef _CDC_H_
+#define _CDC_H_
+
+	/* Includes: */
+		#include <avr/io.h>
+		#include <avr/wdt.h>
+		#include <avr/boot.h>
+		#include <avr/eeprom.h>
+		#include <stdbool.h>
+
+		#include "Descriptors.h"
+
+		#include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h>                // USB Functionality
+
+	/* Macros: */
+		/** CDC Class Specific request to get the line encoding on a CDC-ACM virtual serial port, including the
+		 *  baud rate, parity, stop bits and data bits.
+		 */
+		#define REQ_GetLineEncoding          0x21
+
+		/** CDC Class Specific request to set the line encoding on a CDC-ACM virtual serial port, including the
+		 *  baud rate, parity, stop bits and data bits.
+		 */
+		#define REQ_SetLineEncoding          0x20
+
+		/** CDC Class Specific request to set the state of the serial handshake lines (such as DCD and RTS) on
+		 *  a CDC-ACM virtual serial port.
+		 */
+		#define REQ_SetControlLineState      0x22
+		
+		/** Version major of the CDC bootloader. */
+		#define BOOTLOADER_VERSION_MAJOR     0x01
+
+		/** Version minor of the CDC bootloader. */
+		#define BOOTLOADER_VERSION_MINOR     0x00
+				
+		/** Hardware version major of the CDC bootloader. */
+		#define BOOTLOADER_HWVERSION_MAJOR   0x01
+
+		/** Hardware version minor of the CDC bootloader. */
+		#define BOOTLOADER_HWVERSION_MINOR   0x00
+
+		/** Eight character bootloader firmware identifier reported to the host when requested */
+		#define SOFTWARE_IDENTIFIER          "LUFA-CDC"
+
+	/* Event Handlers: */
+		/** Indicates that this module will catch the USB_Disconnect event when thrown by the library. */
+		HANDLES_EVENT(USB_Disconnect);
+
+		/** Indicates that this module will catch the USB_ConfigurationChanged event when thrown by the library. */
+		HANDLES_EVENT(USB_ConfigurationChanged);
+
+		/** Indicates that this module will catch the USB_UnhandledControlPacket event when thrown by the library. */
+		HANDLES_EVENT(USB_UnhandledControlPacket);
+		
+	/* Type Defines: */
+		/** Type define for a non-returning pointer to the start of the loaded application in flash memory. */
+		typedef void (*AppPtr_t)(void) ATTR_NO_RETURN;
+
+		/** Type define for the CDC-ACM virtual serial port line encoding options, including baud rate, format, parity
+		 *  and size of each data chunk in bits.
+		 */
+		typedef struct
+		{
+			uint32_t BaudRateBPS; /**< Baud rate in BPS */
+			uint8_t  CharFormat; /**< Character format, an entry from the BootloaderCDC_CDC_LineCodingFormats_t enum */
+			uint8_t  ParityType; /**< Parity mode, an entry from the BootloaderCDC_CDC_LineCodeingParity_t enum */
+			uint8_t  DataBits; /**< Size of each data chunk, in bits */
+		} CDC_Line_Coding_t;
+		
+	/* Enums: */
+		/** Enum for the possible line encoding formats on a CDC-ACM virtual serial port */
+		enum BootloaderCDC_CDC_LineCodingFormats_t
+		{
+			OneStopBit          = 0, /**< Single stop bit */
+			OneAndAHalfStopBits = 1, /**< 1.5 stop bits */
+			TwoStopBits         = 2, /**< Two stop bits */
+		};
+		
+		/** Enum for the possible parity modes on a CDC-ACM virtual serial port */
+		enum BootloaderCDC_CDC_LineCodeingParity_t
+		{
+			Parity_None         = 0, /**< No data parity checking */
+			Parity_Odd          = 1, /**< Odd data parity checking */
+			Parity_Even         = 2, /**< Even data parity checking */
+			Parity_Mark         = 3, /**< Mark data parity checking */
+			Parity_Space        = 4, /**< Space data parity checking */
+		};
+		
+	/* Tasks: */
+		TASK(CDC_Task);
+
+	/* Function Prototypes: */
+		#if defined(INCLUDE_FROM_BOOTLOADERCDC_C) || defined(__DOXYGEN__)
+			static void ProgramReadWriteMemoryBlock(const uint8_t Command);
+			static uint8_t FetchNextCommandByte(void);
+			static void WriteNextResponseByte(const uint8_t Response);
+		#endif
+
+#endif
diff --git a/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.txt b/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.txt
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..cb6f9f01f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,40 @@
+/** \file
+ *
+ *  This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special
+ *  documentation pages. It is not a project source file.
+ */
+ 
+/** \mainpage CDC Class USB AVR Bootloader
+ * 
+ * This bootloader enumerates to the host as a CDC Class device (virtual serial port), allowing for AVR109
+ * protocol compatible programming software to load firmware onto the AVR.	
+ *  
+ * Out of the box this bootloader builds for the USB1287, and will fit into 4KB of bootloader space. If
+ * you wish to enlarge this space and/or change the AVR model, you will need to edit the BOOT_START and MCU
+ * values in the accompanying makefile.
+ *  
+ * This bootloader is compatible with the open source application AVRDUDE, or Atmel's AVRPROG.
+ *
+ * <table>
+ *  <tr>
+ *   <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td>
+ *   <td>Device</td>
+ *  </tr>
+ *  <tr>
+ *   <td><b>USB Class:</b></td>
+ *   <td>Communications Device Class (CDC)</td>
+ *  </tr>
+ *  <tr> 
+ *   <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td>
+ *   <td>Abstract Control Model (ACM)</td>
+ *  </tr>
+ *  <tr>
+ *   <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td>
+ *   <td>USBIF CDC Class Standard</td>
+ *  </tr>
+ *  <tr>
+ *   <td><b>Usable Speeds:</b></td>
+ *   <td>Full Speed Mode</td>
+ *  </tr>
+ * </table>
+ */
diff --git a/Bootloaders/CDC/Descriptors.c b/Bootloaders/CDC/Descriptors.c
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..ee0e194d8
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Bootloaders/CDC/Descriptors.c
@@ -0,0 +1,247 @@
+/*
+             LUFA Library
+     Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2009.
+              
+  dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+      www.fourwalledcubicle.com
+*/
+
+/*
+  Copyright 2009  Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com)
+
+  Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software
+  and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby
+  granted, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all
+  copies and that both that the copyright notice and this
+  permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting
+  documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in
+  advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
+  software without specific, written prior permission.
+
+  The author disclaim all warranties with regard to this
+  software, including all implied warranties of merchantability
+  and fitness.  In no event shall the author be liable for any
+  special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages
+  whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether
+  in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action,
+  arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of
+  this software.
+*/
+
+/** \file
+ *
+ *  USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special 
+ *  computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine
+ *  the device's capabilities and functions.  
+ */
+
+#include "Descriptors.h"
+
+/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in SRAM memory, describes the overall
+ *  device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the
+ *  number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration
+ *  process begins.
+ */
+USB_Descriptor_Device_t DeviceDescriptor =
+{
+	Header:                 {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), Type: DTYPE_Device},
+		
+	USBSpecification:       VERSION_BCD(01.10),
+	Class:                  0x02,
+	SubClass:               0x00,
+	Protocol:               0x00,
+				
+	Endpoint0Size:          FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE,
+		
+	VendorID:               0x03EB,
+	ProductID:              0x204A,
+	ReleaseNumber:          0x0000,
+		
+	ManufacturerStrIndex:   NO_DESCRIPTOR,
+	ProductStrIndex:        0x01,
+	SerialNumStrIndex:      NO_DESCRIPTOR,
+		
+	NumberOfConfigurations: 1
+};
+
+/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in SRAM memory, describes the usage
+ *  of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces
+ *  and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting
+ *  a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device.
+ */
+USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t ConfigurationDescriptor =
+{
+	Config:
+		{
+			Header:                 {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), Type: DTYPE_Configuration},
+
+			TotalConfigurationSize: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t),
+			TotalInterfaces:        2,
+				
+			ConfigurationNumber:    1,
+			ConfigurationStrIndex:  NO_DESCRIPTOR,
+				
+			ConfigAttributes:       (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_BUSPOWERED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED),
+			
+			MaxPowerConsumption:    USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100)
+		},
+		
+	CCI_Interface:
+		{
+			Header:                 {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), Type: DTYPE_Interface},
+
+			InterfaceNumber:        0,
+			AlternateSetting:       0,
+			
+			TotalEndpoints:         1,
+				
+			Class:                  0x02,
+			SubClass:               0x02,
+			Protocol:               0x01,
+				
+			InterfaceStrIndex:      NO_DESCRIPTOR
+		},
+
+	CDC_Functional_IntHeader:
+		{
+			Header:                 {Size: sizeof(CDC_FUNCTIONAL_DESCRIPTOR(2)), Type: 0x24},
+			SubType:                0x00,
+			
+			Data:                   {0x10, 0x01}
+		},
+
+	CDC_Functional_CallManagement:
+		{
+			Header:                 {Size: sizeof(CDC_FUNCTIONAL_DESCRIPTOR(2)), Type: 0x24},
+			SubType:                0x01,
+			
+			Data:                   {0x03, 0x01}
+		},
+
+	CDC_Functional_AbstractControlManagement:
+		{
+			Header:                 {Size: sizeof(CDC_FUNCTIONAL_DESCRIPTOR(1)), Type: 0x24},
+			SubType:                0x02,
+			
+			Data:                   {0x06}
+		},
+		
+	CDC_Functional_Union:
+		{
+			Header:                 {Size: sizeof(CDC_FUNCTIONAL_DESCRIPTOR(2)), Type: 0x24},
+			SubType:                0x06,
+			
+			Data:                   {0x00, 0x01}
+		},	
+
+	ManagementEndpoint:
+		{
+			Header:                 {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), Type: DTYPE_Endpoint},
+										 
+			EndpointAddress:        (ENDPOINT_DESCRIPTOR_DIR_IN | CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPNUM),
+			Attributes:       		EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT,
+			EndpointSize:           CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE,
+			PollingIntervalMS:		0x02
+		},
+
+	DCI_Interface:
+		{
+			Header:                 {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), Type: DTYPE_Interface},
+
+			InterfaceNumber:        1,
+			AlternateSetting:       0,
+			
+			TotalEndpoints:         2,
+				
+			Class:                  0x0A,
+			SubClass:               0x00,
+			Protocol:               0x00,
+				
+			InterfaceStrIndex:      NO_DESCRIPTOR
+		},
+
+	DataOutEndpoint:
+		{
+			Header:                 {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), Type: DTYPE_Endpoint},
+										 
+			EndpointAddress:        (ENDPOINT_DESCRIPTOR_DIR_OUT | CDC_RX_EPNUM),
+			Attributes:       		EP_TYPE_BULK,
+			EndpointSize:           CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE,
+			PollingIntervalMS:		0x00
+		},
+		
+	DataInEndpoint:
+		{
+			Header:                 {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), Type: DTYPE_Endpoint},
+										 
+			EndpointAddress:        (ENDPOINT_DESCRIPTOR_DIR_IN | CDC_TX_EPNUM),
+			Attributes:       		EP_TYPE_BULK,
+			EndpointSize:           CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE,
+			PollingIntervalMS:		0x00
+		}
+};
+
+/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in SRAM memory, is returned when the host requests
+ *  the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate
+ *  via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors.
+ */
+USB_Descriptor_String_t LanguageString =
+{
+	Header:                 {Size: USB_STRING_LEN(1), Type: DTYPE_String},
+		
+	UnicodeString:          {LANGUAGE_ID_ENG}
+};
+
+/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form,
+ *  and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device
+ *  Descriptor.
+ */
+USB_Descriptor_String_t ProductString =
+{
+	Header:                 {Size: USB_STRING_LEN(15), Type: DTYPE_String},
+		
+	UnicodeString:          L"AVR CDC Bootloader"
+};
+
+/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see StdDescriptors.h
+ *  documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given
+ *  to the USB library. When the device recieves a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function
+ *  is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the
+ *  USB host.
+ */
+uint16_t USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, const uint8_t wIndex, void** const DescriptorAddress)
+{
+	const uint8_t  DescriptorType   = (wValue >> 8);
+	const uint8_t  DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF);
+
+	void*    Address = NULL;
+	uint16_t Size    = NO_DESCRIPTOR;
+
+	switch (DescriptorType)
+	{
+		case DTYPE_Device:
+			Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(DeviceDescriptor);
+			Size    = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t);
+			break;
+		case DTYPE_Configuration:
+			Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(ConfigurationDescriptor);
+			Size    = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t);
+			break;
+		case DTYPE_String:
+			if (!(DescriptorNumber))
+			{
+				Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(LanguageString);
+				Size    = LanguageString.Header.Size;
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(ProductString);
+				Size    = ProductString.Header.Size;
+			}
+			
+			break;
+	}
+	
+	*DescriptorAddress = Address;
+	return Size;
+}
diff --git a/Bootloaders/CDC/Descriptors.h b/Bootloaders/CDC/Descriptors.h
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..8bd6bdf85
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Bootloaders/CDC/Descriptors.h
@@ -0,0 +1,95 @@
+/*
+             LUFA Library
+     Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2009.
+              
+  dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+      www.fourwalledcubicle.com
+*/
+
+/*
+  Copyright 2009  Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com)
+
+  Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software
+  and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby
+  granted, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all
+  copies and that both that the copyright notice and this
+  permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting
+  documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in
+  advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
+  software without specific, written prior permission.
+
+  The author disclaim all warranties with regard to this
+  software, including all implied warranties of merchantability
+  and fitness.  In no event shall the author be liable for any
+  special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages
+  whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether
+  in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action,
+  arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of
+  this software.
+*/
+
+/** \file
+ *
+ *  Header file for Descriptors.c.
+ */
+
+#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_
+#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_
+
+	/* Includes: */
+		#include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h>
+
+	/* Macros: */
+		/** Structure for a CDC class Functional descriptor, with a given data size. This is used instead of a
+		 *  type define so that the same macro can be used for functional descriptors of varying data lengths,
+		 *  while allowing the sizeof() operator to return correct results.
+		 *
+		 *  \param DataSize  Size of the functional descriptor's data payload, in bytes
+		 */
+		#define CDC_FUNCTIONAL_DESCRIPTOR(DataSize)        \
+		     struct                                        \
+		     {                                             \
+		          USB_Descriptor_Header_t Header;          \
+			      uint8_t                 SubType;         \
+		          uint8_t                 Data[DataSize];  \
+		     }
+
+		/** Endpoint number for the CDC control interface event notification endpoint. */
+		#define CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPNUM         3
+
+		/** Size of the CDC control interface notification endpoint bank, in bytes */
+		#define CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE        8
+
+		/** Endpoint number for the CDC data interface TX (data IN) endpoint */
+		#define CDC_TX_EPNUM                   1	
+
+		/** Endpoint number for the CDC data interface RX (data OUT) endpoint */
+		#define CDC_RX_EPNUM                   2	
+
+		/** Size of the CDC data interface TX and RX data endpoint banks, in bytes */
+		#define CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE                16
+
+	/* Type Defines: */
+		/** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the
+		 *  application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which
+		 *  vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host.
+		 */
+		typedef struct
+		{
+			USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t    Config;
+			USB_Descriptor_Interface_t               CCI_Interface;
+			CDC_FUNCTIONAL_DESCRIPTOR(2)             CDC_Functional_IntHeader;
+			CDC_FUNCTIONAL_DESCRIPTOR(2)             CDC_Functional_CallManagement;
+			CDC_FUNCTIONAL_DESCRIPTOR(1)             CDC_Functional_AbstractControlManagement;
+			CDC_FUNCTIONAL_DESCRIPTOR(2)             CDC_Functional_Union;
+			USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t                ManagementEndpoint;
+			USB_Descriptor_Interface_t               DCI_Interface;
+			USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t                DataOutEndpoint;
+			USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t                DataInEndpoint;
+		} USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t;
+
+	/* Function Prototypes: */
+		uint16_t USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, const uint8_t wIndex, void** const DescriptorAddress)
+		                           ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3);
+
+#endif
diff --git a/Bootloaders/CDC/Doxygen.conf b/Bootloaders/CDC/Doxygen.conf
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..5ba226d2f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Bootloaders/CDC/Doxygen.conf
@@ -0,0 +1,1485 @@
+# Doxyfile 1.5.7.1
+
+# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system
+# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project
+#
+# All text after a hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored
+# The format is:
+#       TAG = value [value, ...]
+# For lists items can also be appended using:
+#       TAG += value [value, ...]
+# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (" ")
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# Project related configuration options
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file 
+# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all 
+# text before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the 
+# iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See 
+# http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv for the list of possible encodings.
+
+DOXYFILE_ENCODING      = UTF-8
+
+# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded 
+# by quotes) that should identify the project.
+
+PROJECT_NAME           = "LUFA Library - CDC Class Bootloader"
+
+# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. 
+# This could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or 
+# if some version control system is used.
+
+PROJECT_NUMBER         = 0.0.0
+
+# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) 
+# base path where the generated documentation will be put. 
+# If a relative path is entered, it will be relative to the location 
+# where doxygen was started. If left blank the current directory will be used.
+
+OUTPUT_DIRECTORY       = ./Documentation/
+
+# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES, then doxygen will create 
+# 4096 sub-directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output 
+# format and will distribute the generated files over these directories. 
+# Enabling this option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of 
+# source files, where putting all generated files in the same directory would 
+# otherwise cause performance problems for the file system.
+
+CREATE_SUBDIRS         = YES
+
+# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all 
+# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this 
+# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. 
+# The default language is English, other supported languages are: 
+# Afrikaans, Arabic, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, Chinese-Traditional, 
+# Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, Farsi, Finnish, French, German, Greek, 
+# Hungarian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), 
+# Korean, Korean-en, Lithuanian, Norwegian, Macedonian, Persian, Polish, 
+# Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, Serbian, Serbian-Cyrilic, Slovak, Slovene, 
+# Spanish, Swedish, and Ukrainian.
+
+OUTPUT_LANGUAGE        = English
+
+# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will 
+# include brief member descriptions after the members that are listed in 
+# the file and class documentation (similar to JavaDoc). 
+# Set to NO to disable this.
+
+BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC      = YES
+
+# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will prepend 
+# the brief description of a member or function before the detailed description. 
+# Note: if both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the 
+# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed.
+
+REPEAT_BRIEF           = YES
+
+# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator 
+# that is used to form the text in various listings. Each string 
+# in this list, if found as the leading text of the brief description, will be 
+# stripped from the text and the result after processing the whole list, is 
+# used as the annotated text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. 
+# If left blank, the following values are used ("$name" is automatically 
+# replaced with the name of the entity): "The $name class" "The $name widget" 
+# "The $name file" "is" "provides" "specifies" "contains" 
+# "represents" "a" "an" "the"
+
+ABBREVIATE_BRIEF       = "The $name class" \
+                         "The $name widget" \
+                         "The $name file" \
+                         is \
+                         provides \
+                         specifies \
+                         contains \
+                         represents \
+                         a \
+                         an \
+                         the
+
+# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then 
+# Doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief 
+# description.
+
+ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC    = NO
+
+# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all 
+# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those 
+# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment 
+# operators of the base classes will not be shown.
+
+INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB  = NO
+
+# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES then Doxygen will prepend the full 
+# path before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set 
+# to NO the shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used.
+
+FULL_PATH_NAMES        = YES
+
+# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES then the STRIP_FROM_PATH tag 
+# can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. Stripping is 
+# only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand part of 
+# the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. 
+# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the 
+# path to strip.
+
+STRIP_FROM_PATH        = 
+
+# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of 
+# the path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells 
+# the reader which header file to include in order to use a class. 
+# If left blank only the name of the header file containing the class 
+# definition is used. Otherwise one should specify the include paths that 
+# are normally passed to the compiler using the -I flag.
+
+STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH    = 
+
+# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter 
+# (but less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems 
+# doesn't support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM.
+
+SHORT_NAMES            = YES
+
+# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then Doxygen 
+# will interpret the first line (until the first dot) of a JavaDoc-style 
+# comment as the brief description. If set to NO, the JavaDoc 
+# comments will behave just like regular Qt-style comments 
+# (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief description.)
+
+JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF      = NO
+
+# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then Doxygen will 
+# interpret the first line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style 
+# comment as the brief description. If set to NO, the comments 
+# will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus requiring 
+# an explicit \brief command for a brief description.)
+
+QT_AUTOBRIEF           = NO
+
+# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make Doxygen 
+# treat a multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// 
+# comments) as a brief description. This used to be the default behaviour. 
+# The new default is to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed 
+# description. Set this tag to YES if you prefer the old behaviour instead.
+
+MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO
+
+# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES (the default) then an undocumented 
+# member inherits the documentation from any documented member that it 
+# re-implements.
+
+INHERIT_DOCS           = YES
+
+# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES, then doxygen will produce 
+# a new page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will 
+# be part of the file/class/namespace that contains it.
+
+SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES  = NO
+
+# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. 
+# Doxygen uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments.
+
+TAB_SIZE               = 4
+
+# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that acts 
+# as commands in the documentation. An alias has the form "name=value". 
+# For example adding "sideeffect=\par Side Effects:\n" will allow you to 
+# put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the documentation, which 
+# will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading "Side Effects:". 
+# You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert newlines.
+
+ALIASES                = 
+
+# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C 
+# sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. 
+# For instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list 
+# of all members will be omitted, etc.
+
+OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C  = YES
+
+# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java 
+# sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for 
+# Java. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, qualified 
+# scopes will look different, etc.
+
+OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA   = NO
+
+# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran 
+# sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for 
+# Fortran.
+
+OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN   = NO
+
+# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL 
+# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for 
+# VHDL.
+
+OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL   = NO
+
+# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want 
+# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should 
+# set this tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and 
+# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); v.s. 
+# func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration 
+# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate.
+
+BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT    = NO
+
+# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to
+# enable parsing support.
+
+CPP_CLI_SUPPORT        = NO
+
+# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip sources only. 
+# Doxygen will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public 
+# instead of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present.
+
+SIP_SUPPORT            = NO
+
+# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate getter 
+# and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES (the default) 
+# will make doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the 
+# documentation. This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or 
+# setting a simple type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the 
+# methods anyway, you should set this option to NO.
+
+IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT   = YES
+
+# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC 
+# tag is set to YES, then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first 
+# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default 
+# all members of a group must be documented explicitly.
+
+DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC   = NO
+
+# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES (the default) to allow class member groups of 
+# the same type (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a 
+# subgroup of that type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to 
+# NO to prevent subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using 
+# the \nosubgrouping command.
+
+SUBGROUPING            = YES
+
+# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or enum 
+# is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So 
+# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct 
+# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, 
+# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically 
+# be useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound 
+# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name.
+
+TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT   = NO
+
+# The SYMBOL_CACHE_SIZE determines the size of the internal cache use to 
+# determine which symbols to keep in memory and which to flush to disk.
+# When the cache is full, less often used symbols will be written to disk.
+# For small to medium size projects (<1000 input files) the default value is 
+# probably good enough. For larger projects a too small cache size can cause 
+# doxygen to be busy swapping symbols to and from disk most of the time 
+# causing a significant performance penality. 
+# If the system has enough physical memory increasing the cache will improve the 
+# performance by keeping more symbols in memory. Note that the value works on 
+# a logarithmic scale so increasing the size by one will rougly double the 
+# memory usage. The cache size is given by this formula: 
+# 2^(16+SYMBOL_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range is 0..9, the default is 0, 
+# corresponding to a cache size of 2^16 = 65536 symbols
+
+SYMBOL_CACHE_SIZE      = 0
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# Build related configuration options
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES doxygen will assume all entities in 
+# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. 
+# Private class members and static file members will be hidden unless 
+# the EXTRACT_PRIVATE and EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES
+
+EXTRACT_ALL            = YES
+
+# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES all private members of a class 
+# will be included in the documentation.
+
+EXTRACT_PRIVATE        = YES
+
+# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES all static members of a file 
+# will be included in the documentation.
+
+EXTRACT_STATIC         = YES
+
+# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES classes (and structs) 
+# defined locally in source files will be included in the documentation. 
+# If set to NO only classes defined in header files are included.
+
+EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES  = YES
+
+# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. When set to YES local 
+# methods, which are defined in the implementation section but not in 
+# the interface are included in the documentation. 
+# If set to NO (the default) only methods in the interface are included.
+
+EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS  = NO
+
+# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be 
+# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called 
+# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base 
+# name of the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default 
+# anonymous namespace are hidden.
+
+EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES   = NO
+
+# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, Doxygen will hide all 
+# undocumented members of documented classes, files or namespaces. 
+# If set to NO (the default) these members will be included in the 
+# various overviews, but no documentation section is generated. 
+# This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled.
+
+HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS     = NO
+
+# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, Doxygen will hide all 
+# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. 
+# If set to NO (the default) these classes will be included in the various 
+# overviews. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled.
+
+HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES     = NO
+
+# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, Doxygen will hide all 
+# friend (class|struct|union) declarations. 
+# If set to NO (the default) these declarations will be included in the 
+# documentation.
+
+HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS  = NO
+
+# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, Doxygen will hide any 
+# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. 
+# If set to NO (the default) these blocks will be appended to the 
+# function's detailed documentation block.
+
+HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS      = NO
+
+# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation 
+# that is typed after a \internal command is included. If the tag is set 
+# to NO (the default) then the documentation will be excluded. 
+# Set it to YES to include the internal documentation.
+
+INTERNAL_DOCS          = NO
+
+# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then Doxygen will only generate 
+# file names in lower-case letters. If set to YES upper-case letters are also 
+# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ 
+# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows 
+# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO.
+
+CASE_SENSE_NAMES       = NO
+
+# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO (the default) then Doxygen 
+# will show members with their full class and namespace scopes in the 
+# documentation. If set to YES the scope will be hidden.
+
+HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES       = NO
+
+# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES (the default) then Doxygen 
+# will put a list of the files that are included by a file in the documentation 
+# of that file.
+
+SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES     = YES
+
+# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES (the default) then a tag [inline] 
+# is inserted in the documentation for inline members.
+
+INLINE_INFO            = YES
+
+# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES (the default) then doxygen 
+# will sort the (detailed) documentation of file and class members 
+# alphabetically by member name. If set to NO the members will appear in 
+# declaration order.
+
+SORT_MEMBER_DOCS       = YES
+
+# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the 
+# brief documentation of file, namespace and class members alphabetically 
+# by member name. If set to NO (the default) the members will appear in 
+# declaration order.
+
+SORT_BRIEF_DOCS        = NO
+
+# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the 
+# hierarchy of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO (the default) 
+# the group names will appear in their defined order.
+
+SORT_GROUP_NAMES       = NO
+
+# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be 
+# sorted by fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to 
+# NO (the default), the class list will be sorted only by class name, 
+# not including the namespace part. 
+# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES.
+# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the 
+# alphabetical list.
+
+SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME     = NO
+
+# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or 
+# disable (NO) the todo list. This list is created by putting \todo 
+# commands in the documentation.
+
+GENERATE_TODOLIST      = NO
+
+# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or 
+# disable (NO) the test list. This list is created by putting \test 
+# commands in the documentation.
+
+GENERATE_TESTLIST      = NO
+
+# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or 
+# disable (NO) the bug list. This list is created by putting \bug 
+# commands in the documentation.
+
+GENERATE_BUGLIST       = NO
+
+# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or 
+# disable (NO) the deprecated list. This list is created by putting 
+# \deprecated commands in the documentation.
+
+GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES
+
+# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional 
+# documentation sections, marked by \if sectionname ... \endif.
+
+ENABLED_SECTIONS       = 
+
+# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines 
+# the initial value of a variable or define consists of for it to appear in 
+# the documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified 
+# here it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. 
+# The appearance of the initializer of individual variables and defines in the 
+# documentation can be controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer 
+# command in the documentation regardless of this setting.
+
+MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES  = 30
+
+# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated 
+# at the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES the 
+# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation.
+
+SHOW_USED_FILES        = YES
+
+# If the sources in your project are distributed over multiple directories 
+# then setting the SHOW_DIRECTORIES tag to YES will show the directory hierarchy 
+# in the documentation. The default is NO.
+
+SHOW_DIRECTORIES       = YES
+
+# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page.
+# This will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the 
+# Folder Tree View (if specified). The default is YES.
+
+SHOW_FILES             = YES
+
+# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the 
+# Namespaces page.  This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index
+# and from the Folder Tree View (if specified). The default is YES.
+
+SHOW_NAMESPACES        = YES
+
+# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that 
+# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from 
+# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via 
+# popen()) the command <command> <input-file>, where <command> is the value of 
+# the FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the name of an input file 
+# provided by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output 
+# is used as the file version. See the manual for examples.
+
+FILE_VERSION_FILTER    = 
+
+# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed by 
+# doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated output files 
+# in an output format independent way. The create the layout file that represents 
+# doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can optionally specify a 
+# file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml will be used as the name 
+# of the layout file.
+
+LAYOUT_FILE            = 
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to warning and progress messages
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated 
+# by doxygen. Possible values are YES and NO. If left blank NO is used.
+
+QUIET                  = YES
+
+# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are 
+# generated by doxygen. Possible values are YES and NO. If left blank 
+# NO is used.
+
+WARNINGS               = YES
+
+# If WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED is set to YES, then doxygen will generate warnings 
+# for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag will 
+# automatically be disabled.
+
+WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED   = YES
+
+# If WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for 
+# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some 
+# parameters in a documented function, or documenting parameters that 
+# don't exist or using markup commands wrongly.
+
+WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR      = YES
+
+# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be abled to get warnings for 
+# functions that are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters 
+# or return value. If set to NO (the default) doxygen will only warn about 
+# wrong or incomplete parameter documentation, but not about the absence of 
+# documentation.
+
+WARN_NO_PARAMDOC       = YES
+
+# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that 
+# doxygen can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text 
+# tags, which will be replaced by the file and line number from which the 
+# warning originated and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain 
+# $version, which will be replaced by the version of the file (if it could 
+# be obtained via FILE_VERSION_FILTER)
+
+WARN_FORMAT            = "$file:$line: $text"
+
+# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning 
+# and error messages should be written. If left blank the output is written 
+# to stderr.
+
+WARN_LOGFILE           = 
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the input files
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# The INPUT tag can be used to specify the files and/or directories that contain 
+# documented source files. You may enter file names like "myfile.cpp" or 
+# directories like "/usr/src/myproject". Separate the files or directories 
+# with spaces.
+
+INPUT                  = ./
+
+# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files 
+# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding, which is 
+# also the default input encoding. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv built 
+# into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv for 
+# the list of possible encodings.
+
+INPUT_ENCODING         = UTF-8
+
+# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the 
+# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp 
+# and *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left 
+# blank the following patterns are tested: 
+# *.c *.cc *.cxx *.cpp *.c++ *.java *.ii *.ixx *.ipp *.i++ *.inl *.h *.hh *.hxx 
+# *.hpp *.h++ *.idl *.odl *.cs *.php *.php3 *.inc *.m *.mm *.py *.f90
+
+FILE_PATTERNS          = *.h \
+                         *.c \
+						 *.txt
+
+# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to turn specify whether or not subdirectories 
+# should be searched for input files as well. Possible values are YES and NO. 
+# If left blank NO is used.
+
+RECURSIVE              = YES
+
+# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should 
+# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a 
+# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag.
+
+EXCLUDE                = 
+
+# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used select whether or not files or 
+# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix filesystem feature) are excluded 
+# from the input.
+
+EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS       = NO
+
+# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the 
+# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude 
+# certain files from those directories. Note that the wildcards are matched 
+# against the file with absolute path, so to exclude all test directories 
+# for example use the pattern */test/*
+
+EXCLUDE_PATTERNS       = */LowLevel/USBMode.h
+
+# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names 
+# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the 
+# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the 
+# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, 
+# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test
+
+EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS        = __*
+
+# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or 
+# directories that contain example code fragments that are included (see 
+# the \include command).
+
+EXAMPLE_PATH           = 
+
+# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the 
+# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp 
+# and *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left 
+# blank all files are included.
+
+EXAMPLE_PATTERNS       = *
+
+# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be 
+# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude 
+# commands irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. 
+# Possible values are YES and NO. If left blank NO is used.
+
+EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE      = NO
+
+# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or 
+# directories that contain image that are included in the documentation (see 
+# the \image command).
+
+IMAGE_PATH             = 
+
+# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should 
+# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program 
+# by executing (via popen()) the command <filter> <input-file>, where <filter> 
+# is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the name of an 
+# input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter program writes 
+# to standard output.  If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag will be 
+# ignored.
+
+INPUT_FILTER           = 
+
+# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern 
+# basis.  Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the 
+# filter if there is a match.  The filters are a list of the form: 
+# pattern=filter (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further 
+# info on how filters are used. If FILTER_PATTERNS is empty, INPUT_FILTER 
+# is applied to all files.
+
+FILTER_PATTERNS        = 
+
+# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using 
+# INPUT_FILTER) will be used to filter the input files when producing source 
+# files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES).
+
+FILTER_SOURCE_FILES    = NO
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to source browsing
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will 
+# be generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. 
+# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure also 
+# VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO.
+
+SOURCE_BROWSER         = NO
+
+# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body 
+# of functions and classes directly in the documentation.
+
+INLINE_SOURCES         = NO
+
+# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES (the default) will instruct 
+# doxygen to hide any special comment blocks from generated source code 
+# fragments. Normal C and C++ comments will always remain visible.
+
+STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS    = YES
+
+# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES 
+# then for each documented function all documented 
+# functions referencing it will be listed.
+
+REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO
+
+# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES 
+# then for each documented function all documented entities 
+# called/used by that function will be listed.
+
+REFERENCES_RELATION    = NO
+
+# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES (the default)
+# and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES, then the hyperlinks from
+# functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will
+# link to the source code.  Otherwise they will link to the documentstion.
+
+REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO
+
+# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code 
+# will point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen 
+# built-in source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source 
+# tagging system (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You 
+# will need version 4.8.6 or higher.
+
+USE_HTAGS              = NO
+
+# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set to YES (the default) then Doxygen 
+# will generate a verbatim copy of the header file for each class for 
+# which an include is specified. Set to NO to disable this.
+
+VERBATIM_HEADERS       = NO
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the alphabetical class index
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index 
+# of all compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project 
+# contains a lot of classes, structs, unions or interfaces.
+
+ALPHABETICAL_INDEX     = YES
+
+# If the alphabetical index is enabled (see ALPHABETICAL_INDEX) then 
+# the COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns 
+# in which this list will be split (can be a number in the range [1..20])
+
+COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX    = 5
+
+# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all 
+# classes will be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. 
+# The IGNORE_PREFIX tag can be used to specify one or more prefixes that 
+# should be ignored while generating the index headers.
+
+IGNORE_PREFIX          = 
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the HTML output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will 
+# generate HTML output.
+
+GENERATE_HTML          = YES
+
+# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. 
+# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be 
+# put in front of it. If left blank `html' will be used as the default path.
+
+HTML_OUTPUT            = html
+
+# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for 
+# each generated HTML page (for example: .htm,.php,.asp). If it is left blank 
+# doxygen will generate files with .html extension.
+
+HTML_FILE_EXTENSION    = .html
+
+# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal HTML header for 
+# each generated HTML page. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a 
+# standard header.
+
+HTML_HEADER            = 
+
+# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal HTML footer for 
+# each generated HTML page. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a 
+# standard footer.
+
+HTML_FOOTER            = 
+
+# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading 
+# style sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to 
+# fine-tune the look of the HTML output. If the tag is left blank doxygen 
+# will generate a default style sheet. Note that doxygen will try to copy 
+# the style sheet file to the HTML output directory, so don't put your own 
+# stylesheet in the HTML output directory as well, or it will be erased!
+
+HTML_STYLESHEET        = 
+
+# If the HTML_ALIGN_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, the members of classes, 
+# files or namespaces will be aligned in HTML using tables. If set to 
+# NO a bullet list will be used.
+
+HTML_ALIGN_MEMBERS     = YES
+
+# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML 
+# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the 
+# page has loaded. For this to work a browser that supports 
+# JavaScript and DHTML is required (for instance Mozilla 1.0+, Firefox 
+# Netscape 6.0+, Internet explorer 5.0+, Konqueror, or Safari).
+
+HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS  = YES
+
+# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files 
+# will be generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 
+# integrated development environment, introduced with OSX 10.5 (Leopard). 
+# To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a Makefile in the 
+# HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in that 
+# directory and running "make install" will install the docset in 
+# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find 
+# it at startup. 
+# See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html for more information.
+
+GENERATE_DOCSET        = NO
+
+# When GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, this tag determines the name of the 
+# feed. A documentation feed provides an umbrella under which multiple 
+# documentation sets from a single provider (such as a company or product suite) 
+# can be grouped.
+
+DOCSET_FEEDNAME        = "Doxygen generated docs"
+
+# When GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, this tag specifies a string that 
+# should uniquely identify the documentation set bundle. This should be a 
+# reverse domain-name style string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen 
+# will append .docset to the name.
+
+DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID       = org.doxygen.Project
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files 
+# will be generated that can be used as input for tools like the 
+# Microsoft HTML help workshop to generate a compiled HTML help file (.chm) 
+# of the generated HTML documentation.
+
+GENERATE_HTMLHELP      = NO
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the CHM_FILE tag can 
+# be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm file. You 
+# can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be 
+# written to the html output directory.
+
+CHM_FILE               = 
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the HHC_LOCATION tag can 
+# be used to specify the location (absolute path including file name) of 
+# the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty doxygen will try to run 
+# the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp.
+
+HHC_LOCATION           = 
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the GENERATE_CHI flag 
+# controls if a separate .chi index file is generated (YES) or that 
+# it should be included in the master .chm file (NO).
+
+GENERATE_CHI           = NO
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the CHM_INDEX_ENCODING
+# is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) and project file
+# content.
+
+CHM_INDEX_ENCODING     = 
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the BINARY_TOC flag 
+# controls whether a binary table of contents is generated (YES) or a 
+# normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file.
+
+BINARY_TOC             = NO
+
+# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members 
+# to the contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view.
+
+TOC_EXPAND             = YES
+
+# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER 
+# are set, an additional index file will be generated that can be used as input for 
+# Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help (.qch) of the generated 
+# HTML documentation.
+
+GENERATE_QHP           = NO
+
+# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can 
+# be used to specify the file name of the resulting .qch file. 
+# The path specified is relative to the HTML output folder.
+
+QCH_FILE               = 
+
+# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating 
+# Qt Help Project output. For more information please see 
+# <a href="http://doc.trolltech.com/qthelpproject.html#namespace">Qt Help Project / Namespace</a>.
+
+QHP_NAMESPACE          = org.doxygen.Project
+
+# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating 
+# Qt Help Project output. For more information please see 
+# <a href="http://doc.trolltech.com/qthelpproject.html#virtual-folders">Qt Help Project / Virtual Folders</a>.
+
+QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER     = doc
+
+# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES, the QHG_LOCATION tag can 
+# be used to specify the location of Qt's qhelpgenerator. 
+# If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the generated 
+# .qhp file .
+
+QHG_LOCATION           = 
+
+# The DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index at 
+# top of each HTML page. The value NO (the default) enables the index and 
+# the value YES disables it.
+
+DISABLE_INDEX          = NO
+
+# This tag can be used to set the number of enum values (range [1..20]) 
+# that doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation.
+
+ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE   = 1
+
+# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index
+# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information.
+# If the tag value is set to FRAME, a side panel will be generated
+# containing a tree-like index structure (just like the one that 
+# is generated for HTML Help). For this to work a browser that supports 
+# JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required (for instance Mozilla 1.0+, 
+# Netscape 6.0+, Internet explorer 5.0+, or Konqueror). Windows users are 
+# probably better off using the HTML help feature. Other possible values 
+# for this tag are: HIERARCHIES, which will generate the Groups, Directories,
+# and Class Hierarchy pages using a tree view instead of an ordered list;
+# ALL, which combines the behavior of FRAME and HIERARCHIES; and NONE, which
+# disables this behavior completely. For backwards compatibility with previous
+# releases of Doxygen, the values YES and NO are equivalent to FRAME and NONE
+# respectively.
+
+GENERATE_TREEVIEW      = YES
+
+# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be 
+# used to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree 
+# is shown.
+
+TREEVIEW_WIDTH         = 250
+
+# Use this tag to change the font size of Latex formulas included 
+# as images in the HTML documentation. The default is 10. Note that 
+# when you change the font size after a successful doxygen run you need 
+# to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML output directory 
+# to force them to be regenerated.
+
+FORMULA_FONTSIZE       = 10
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the LaTeX output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will 
+# generate Latex output.
+
+GENERATE_LATEX         = NO
+
+# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. 
+# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be 
+# put in front of it. If left blank `latex' will be used as the default path.
+
+LATEX_OUTPUT           = latex
+
+# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be 
+# invoked. If left blank `latex' will be used as the default command name.
+
+LATEX_CMD_NAME         = latex
+
+# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to 
+# generate index for LaTeX. If left blank `makeindex' will be used as the 
+# default command name.
+
+MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME     = makeindex
+
+# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES Doxygen generates more compact 
+# LaTeX documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to 
+# save some trees in general.
+
+COMPACT_LATEX          = NO
+
+# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used 
+# by the printer. Possible values are: a4, a4wide, letter, legal and 
+# executive. If left blank a4wide will be used.
+
+PAPER_TYPE             = a4wide
+
+# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be to specify one or more names of LaTeX 
+# packages that should be included in the LaTeX output.
+
+EXTRA_PACKAGES         = 
+
+# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for 
+# the generated latex document. The header should contain everything until 
+# the first chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a 
+# standard header. Notice: only use this tag if you know what you are doing!
+
+LATEX_HEADER           = 
+
+# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated 
+# is prepared for conversion to pdf (using ps2pdf). The pdf file will 
+# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references 
+# This makes the output suitable for online browsing using a pdf viewer.
+
+PDF_HYPERLINKS         = YES
+
+# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, pdflatex will be used instead of 
+# plain latex in the generated Makefile. Set this option to YES to get a 
+# higher quality PDF documentation.
+
+USE_PDFLATEX           = YES
+
+# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \\batchmode. 
+# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep 
+# running if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. 
+# This option is also used when generating formulas in HTML.
+
+LATEX_BATCHMODE        = NO
+
+# If LATEX_HIDE_INDICES is set to YES then doxygen will not 
+# include the index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) 
+# in the output.
+
+LATEX_HIDE_INDICES     = NO
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the RTF output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES Doxygen will generate RTF output 
+# The RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look very pretty with 
+# other RTF readers or editors.
+
+GENERATE_RTF           = NO
+
+# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. 
+# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be 
+# put in front of it. If left blank `rtf' will be used as the default path.
+
+RTF_OUTPUT             = rtf
+
+# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES Doxygen generates more compact 
+# RTF documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to 
+# save some trees in general.
+
+COMPACT_RTF            = NO
+
+# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated 
+# will contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will 
+# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. 
+# This makes the output suitable for online browsing using WORD or other 
+# programs which support those fields. 
+# Note: wordpad (write) and others do not support links.
+
+RTF_HYPERLINKS         = NO
+
+# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's 
+# config file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide 
+# replacements, missing definitions are set to their default value.
+
+RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE    = 
+
+# Set optional variables used in the generation of an rtf document. 
+# Syntax is similar to doxygen's config file.
+
+RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE    = 
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the man page output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will 
+# generate man pages
+
+GENERATE_MAN           = NO
+
+# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. 
+# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be 
+# put in front of it. If left blank `man' will be used as the default path.
+
+MAN_OUTPUT             = man
+
+# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to 
+# the generated man pages (default is the subroutine's section .3)
+
+MAN_EXTENSION          = .3
+
+# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and Doxygen generates man output, 
+# then it will generate one additional man file for each entity 
+# documented in the real man page(s). These additional files 
+# only source the real man page, but without them the man command 
+# would be unable to find the correct page. The default is NO.
+
+MAN_LINKS              = NO
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the XML output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES Doxygen will 
+# generate an XML file that captures the structure of 
+# the code including all documentation.
+
+GENERATE_XML           = NO
+
+# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. 
+# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be 
+# put in front of it. If left blank `xml' will be used as the default path.
+
+XML_OUTPUT             = xml
+
+# The XML_SCHEMA tag can be used to specify an XML schema, 
+# which can be used by a validating XML parser to check the 
+# syntax of the XML files.
+
+XML_SCHEMA             = 
+
+# The XML_DTD tag can be used to specify an XML DTD, 
+# which can be used by a validating XML parser to check the 
+# syntax of the XML files.
+
+XML_DTD                = 
+
+# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES Doxygen will 
+# dump the program listings (including syntax highlighting 
+# and cross-referencing information) to the XML output. Note that 
+# enabling this will significantly increase the size of the XML output.
+
+XML_PROGRAMLISTING     = YES
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES Doxygen will 
+# generate an AutoGen Definitions (see autogen.sf.net) file 
+# that captures the structure of the code including all 
+# documentation. Note that this feature is still experimental 
+# and incomplete at the moment.
+
+GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF   = NO
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the Perl module output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES Doxygen will 
+# generate a Perl module file that captures the structure of 
+# the code including all documentation. Note that this 
+# feature is still experimental and incomplete at the 
+# moment.
+
+GENERATE_PERLMOD       = NO
+
+# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES Doxygen will generate 
+# the necessary Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able 
+# to generate PDF and DVI output from the Perl module output.
+
+PERLMOD_LATEX          = NO
+
+# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES the Perl module output will be 
+# nicely formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader.  This is useful 
+# if you want to understand what is going on.  On the other hand, if this 
+# tag is set to NO the size of the Perl module output will be much smaller 
+# and Perl will parse it just the same.
+
+PERLMOD_PRETTY         = YES
+
+# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file 
+# are prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. 
+# This is useful so different doxyrules.make files included by the same 
+# Makefile don't overwrite each other's variables.
+
+PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = 
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# Configuration options related to the preprocessor   
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will 
+# evaluate all C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include 
+# files.
+
+ENABLE_PREPROCESSING   = YES
+
+# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES Doxygen will expand all macro 
+# names in the source code. If set to NO (the default) only conditional 
+# compilation will be performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled 
+# way by setting EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES.
+
+MACRO_EXPANSION        = YES
+
+# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES 
+# then the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the 
+# PREDEFINED and EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags.
+
+EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF     = YES
+
+# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES (the default) the includes files 
+# in the INCLUDE_PATH (see below) will be search if a #include is found.
+
+SEARCH_INCLUDES        = YES
+
+# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that 
+# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by 
+# the preprocessor.
+
+INCLUDE_PATH           = 
+
+# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard 
+# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the 
+# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will 
+# be used.
+
+INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS  = 
+
+# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that 
+# are defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of 
+# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name 
+# or name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the = are 
+# omitted =1 is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being 
+# undefined via #undef or recursively expanded use the := operator 
+# instead of the = operator.
+
+PREDEFINED             = __DOXYGEN__
+
+# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then 
+# this tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. 
+# The macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. 
+# Use the PREDEFINED tag if you want to use a different macro definition.
+
+EXPAND_AS_DEFINED      = BUTTLOADTAG
+
+# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES (the default) then 
+# doxygen's preprocessor will remove all function-like macros that are alone 
+# on a line, have an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such 
+# function macros are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse 
+# the parser if not removed.
+
+SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS   = YES
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# Configuration::additions related to external references   
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# The TAGFILES option can be used to specify one or more tagfiles. 
+# Optionally an initial location of the external documentation 
+# can be added for each tagfile. The format of a tag file without 
+# this location is as follows: 
+#   TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... 
+# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: 
+#   TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... 
+# where "loc1" and "loc2" can be relative or absolute paths or 
+# URLs. If a location is present for each tag, the installdox tool 
+# does not have to be run to correct the links.
+# Note that each tag file must have a unique name
+# (where the name does NOT include the path)
+# If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen 
+# is run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here.
+
+TAGFILES               = 
+
+# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create 
+# a tag file that is based on the input files it reads.
+
+GENERATE_TAGFILE       = 
+
+# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES all external classes will be listed 
+# in the class index. If set to NO only the inherited external classes 
+# will be listed.
+
+ALLEXTERNALS           = NO
+
+# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES all external groups will be listed 
+# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will 
+# be listed.
+
+EXTERNAL_GROUPS        = YES
+
+# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script 
+# interpreter (i.e. the result of `which perl').
+
+PERL_PATH              = /usr/bin/perl
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# Configuration options related to the dot tool   
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will 
+# generate a inheritance diagram (in HTML, RTF and LaTeX) for classes with base 
+# or super classes. Setting the tag to NO turns the diagrams off. Note that 
+# this option is superseded by the HAVE_DOT option below. This is only a 
+# fallback. It is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more 
+# powerful graphs.
+
+CLASS_DIAGRAMS         = NO
+
+# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc 
+# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see 
+# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/) to produce the chart and insert it in the 
+# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where 
+# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the 
+# default search path.
+
+MSCGEN_PATH            = 
+
+# If set to YES, the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide 
+# inheritance and usage relations if the target is undocumented 
+# or is not a class.
+
+HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS   = YES
+
+# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is 
+# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz, a graph visualization 
+# toolkit from AT&T and Lucent Bell Labs. The other options in this section 
+# have no effect if this option is set to NO (the default)
+
+HAVE_DOT               = NO
+
+# By default doxygen will write a font called FreeSans.ttf to the output 
+# directory and reference it in all dot files that doxygen generates. This 
+# font does not include all possible unicode characters however, so when you need 
+# these (or just want a differently looking font) you can specify the font name 
+# using DOT_FONTNAME. You need need to make sure dot is able to find the font, 
+# which can be done by putting it in a standard location or by setting the 
+# DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory 
+# containing the font.
+
+DOT_FONTNAME           = FreeSans
+
+# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size of the font of dot graphs. 
+# The default size is 10pt.
+
+DOT_FONTSIZE           = 10
+
+# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the output directory to look for the 
+# FreeSans.ttf font (which doxygen will put there itself). If you specify a 
+# different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set the path where dot 
+# can find it using this tag.
+
+DOT_FONTPATH           = 
+
+# If the CLASS_GRAPH and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen 
+# will generate a graph for each documented class showing the direct and 
+# indirect inheritance relations. Setting this tag to YES will force the 
+# the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO.
+
+CLASS_GRAPH            = NO
+
+# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen 
+# will generate a graph for each documented class showing the direct and 
+# indirect implementation dependencies (inheritance, containment, and 
+# class references variables) of the class with other documented classes.
+
+COLLABORATION_GRAPH    = NO
+
+# If the GROUP_GRAPHS and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen 
+# will generate a graph for groups, showing the direct groups dependencies
+
+GROUP_GRAPHS           = NO
+
+# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES doxygen will generate inheritance and 
+# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling 
+# Language.
+
+UML_LOOK               = NO
+
+# If set to YES, the inheritance and collaboration graphs will show the 
+# relations between templates and their instances.
+
+TEMPLATE_RELATIONS     = NO
+
+# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING, SEARCH_INCLUDES, INCLUDE_GRAPH, and HAVE_DOT 
+# tags are set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented 
+# file showing the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with 
+# other documented files.
+
+INCLUDE_GRAPH          = NO
+
+# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING, SEARCH_INCLUDES, INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, and 
+# HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each 
+# documented header file showing the documented files that directly or 
+# indirectly include this file.
+
+INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH      = NO
+
+# If the CALL_GRAPH and HAVE_DOT options are set to YES then 
+# doxygen will generate a call dependency graph for every global function 
+# or class method. Note that enabling this option will significantly increase 
+# the time of a run. So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs 
+# for selected functions only using the \callgraph command.
+
+CALL_GRAPH             = NO
+
+# If the CALLER_GRAPH and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then 
+# doxygen will generate a caller dependency graph for every global function 
+# or class method. Note that enabling this option will significantly increase 
+# the time of a run. So in most cases it will be better to enable caller 
+# graphs for selected functions only using the \callergraph command.
+
+CALLER_GRAPH           = NO
+
+# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen 
+# will graphical hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one.
+
+GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY    = NO
+
+# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH, SHOW_DIRECTORIES and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES 
+# then doxygen will show the dependencies a directory has on other directories 
+# in a graphical way. The dependency relations are determined by the #include
+# relations between the files in the directories.
+
+DIRECTORY_GRAPH        = NO
+
+# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images 
+# generated by dot. Possible values are png, jpg, or gif
+# If left blank png will be used.
+
+DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT       = png
+
+# The tag DOT_PATH can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be 
+# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path.
+
+DOT_PATH               = "C:/Program Files/Graphviz2.18/bin"
+
+# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that 
+# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the 
+# \dotfile command).
+
+DOTFILE_DIRS           = 
+
+# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of 
+# nodes that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph 
+# becomes larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is 
+# visualized by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the 
+# number of direct children of the root node in a graph is already larger than 
+# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note 
+# that the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH.
+
+DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES    = 15
+
+# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the 
+# graphs generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable 
+# from the root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes 
+# that lay further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this 
+# option to 1 or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large 
+# code bases. Also note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by 
+# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction.
+
+MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH    = 2
+
+# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent 
+# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not 
+# seem to support this out of the box. Warning: Depending on the platform used, 
+# enabling this option may lead to badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of 
+# a graph (i.e. they become hard to read).
+
+DOT_TRANSPARENT        = YES
+
+# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES allow dot to generate multiple output 
+# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This 
+# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) 
+# support this, this feature is disabled by default.
+
+DOT_MULTI_TARGETS      = NO
+
+# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will 
+# generate a legend page explaining the meaning of the various boxes and 
+# arrows in the dot generated graphs.
+
+GENERATE_LEGEND        = YES
+
+# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will 
+# remove the intermediate dot files that are used to generate 
+# the various graphs.
+
+DOT_CLEANUP            = YES
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# Configuration::additions related to the search engine   
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# The SEARCHENGINE tag specifies whether or not a search engine should be 
+# used. If set to NO the values of all tags below this one will be ignored.
+
+SEARCHENGINE           = NO
diff --git a/Bootloaders/CDC/LUFA CDC Bootloader.inf b/Bootloaders/CDC/LUFA CDC Bootloader.inf
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..6df089ab7
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Bootloaders/CDC/LUFA CDC Bootloader.inf	
@@ -0,0 +1,55 @@
+;       Windows LUFA CDC Setup File
+; Copyright (c) 2000 Microsoft Corporation
+
+[Version] 
+Signature="$Windows NT$" 
+Class=Ports
+ClassGuid={4D36E978-E325-11CE-BFC1-08002BE10318} 
+Provider=%COMPANY% 
+LayoutFile=layout.inf
+DriverVer=06/06/2006,1.0.0.0
+
+[Manufacturer] 
+%MFGNAME% = ManufName
+
+[DestinationDirs] 
+DefaultDestDir=12 
+
+[ManufName] 
+%Modem3% = Modem3, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204A
+
+;------------------------------------------------------------------------------
+;  Windows 2000/XP Sections
+;------------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+[Modem3.nt]
+CopyFiles=USBModemCopyFileSection
+AddReg=Modem3.nt.AddReg 
+
+[USBModemCopyFileSection]
+usbser.sys,,,0x20
+
+[Modem3.nt.AddReg] 
+HKR,,DevLoader,,*ntkern 
+HKR,,NTMPDriver,,usbser.sys 
+HKR,,EnumPropPages32,,"MsPorts.dll,SerialPortPropPageProvider" 
+
+[Modem3.nt.Services] 
+AddService=usbser, 0x00000002, DriverService
+
+[DriverService] 
+DisplayName=%SERVICE%
+ServiceType=1
+StartType=3
+ErrorControl=1
+ServiceBinary=%12%\usbser.sys 
+
+;------------------------------------------------------------------------------
+;  String Definitions
+;------------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+[Strings] 
+COMPANY="LUFA Library"
+MFGNAME="Dean Camera"
+Modem3="USB AVR109 Bootloader" 
+SERVICE="USB Virtual Serial Port CDC Driver"
\ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/Bootloaders/CDC/makefile b/Bootloaders/CDC/makefile
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..3fa8ad4ff
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Bootloaders/CDC/makefile
@@ -0,0 +1,711 @@
+# Hey Emacs, this is a -*- makefile -*-
+#----------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# WinAVR Makefile Template written by Eric B. Weddington, J�rg Wunsch, et al.
+#  >> Modified for use with the LUFA project. <<
+#
+# Released to the Public Domain
+#
+# Additional material for this makefile was written by:
+# Peter Fleury
+# Tim Henigan
+# Colin O'Flynn
+# Reiner Patommel
+# Markus Pfaff
+# Sander Pool
+# Frederik Rouleau
+# Carlos Lamas
+# Dean Camera
+# Opendous Inc.
+# Denver Gingerich
+#
+#----------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# On command line:
+#
+# make all = Make software.
+#
+# make clean = Clean out built project files.
+#
+# make coff = Convert ELF to AVR COFF.
+#
+# make extcoff = Convert ELF to AVR Extended COFF.
+#
+# make program = Download the hex file to the device, using avrdude.
+#                Please customize the avrdude settings below first!
+#
+# make dfu = Download the hex file to the device, using dfu-programmer (must
+#            have dfu-programmer installed).
+#
+# make flip = Download the hex file to the device, using Atmel FLIP (must
+#             have Atmel FLIP installed).
+#
+# make dfu-ee = Download the eeprom file to the device, using dfu-programmer
+#               (must have dfu-programmer installed).
+#
+# make flip-ee = Download the eeprom file to the device, using Atmel FLIP
+#                (must have Atmel FLIP installed).
+#
+# make doxygen = Generate DoxyGen documentation for the project (must have
+#                DoxyGen installed)
+#
+# make debug = Start either simulavr or avarice as specified for debugging, 
+#              with avr-gdb or avr-insight as the front end for debugging.
+#
+# make filename.s = Just compile filename.c into the assembler code only.
+#
+# make filename.i = Create a preprocessed source file for use in submitting
+#                   bug reports to the GCC project.
+#
+# To rebuild project do "make clean" then "make all".
+#----------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+
+# MCU name
+MCU = at90usb1287
+
+
+# Target board (see library BoardTypes.h documentation, USER or blank for projects not requiring
+# LUFA board drivers). If USER is selected, put custom board drivers in a directory called 
+# "Board" inside the application directory.
+BOARD  = USBKEY
+
+
+# Processor frequency.
+#     This will define a symbol, F_CPU, in all source code files equal to the 
+#     processor frequency. You can then use this symbol in your source code to 
+#     calculate timings. Do NOT tack on a 'UL' at the end, this will be done
+#     automatically to create a 32-bit value in your source code.
+#     Typical values are:
+#         F_CPU =  1000000
+#         F_CPU =  1843200
+#         F_CPU =  2000000
+#         F_CPU =  3686400
+#         F_CPU =  4000000
+#         F_CPU =  7372800
+#         F_CPU =  8000000
+#         F_CPU = 11059200
+#         F_CPU = 14745600
+#         F_CPU = 16000000
+#         F_CPU = 18432000
+#         F_CPU = 20000000
+F_CPU = 8000000
+
+
+# Output format. (can be srec, ihex, binary)
+FORMAT = ihex
+
+
+# Target file name (without extension).
+TARGET = BootloaderCDC
+
+
+# Object files directory
+#     To put object files in current directory, use a dot (.), do NOT make
+#     this an empty or blank macro!
+OBJDIR = .
+
+
+# List C source files here. (C dependencies are automatically generated.)
+SRC = $(TARGET).c                                          \
+	  Descriptors.c                                        \
+	  ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/LowLevel.c           \
+	  ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/Endpoint.c           \
+	  ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/DevChapter9.c        \
+	  ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/USBTask.c           \
+	  ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/USBInterrupt.c      \
+	  ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/Events.c            \
+	  ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/StdDescriptors.c    \
+	  
+# List C++ source files here. (C dependencies are automatically generated.)
+CPPSRC = 
+
+
+# List Assembler source files here.
+#     Make them always end in a capital .S.  Files ending in a lowercase .s
+#     will not be considered source files but generated files (assembler
+#     output from the compiler), and will be deleted upon "make clean"!
+#     Even though the DOS/Win* filesystem matches both .s and .S the same,
+#     it will preserve the spelling of the filenames, and gcc itself does
+#     care about how the name is spelled on its command-line.
+ASRC =
+
+
+# Optimization level, can be [0, 1, 2, 3, s]. 
+#     0 = turn off optimization. s = optimize for size.
+#     (Note: 3 is not always the best optimization level. See avr-libc FAQ.)
+OPT = s
+
+
+# Debugging format.
+#     Native formats for AVR-GCC's -g are dwarf-2 [default] or stabs.
+#     AVR Studio 4.10 requires dwarf-2.
+#     AVR [Extended] COFF format requires stabs, plus an avr-objcopy run.
+DEBUG = dwarf-2
+
+
+# List any extra directories to look for include files here.
+#     Each directory must be seperated by a space.
+#     Use forward slashes for directory separators.
+#     For a directory that has spaces, enclose it in quotes.
+EXTRAINCDIRS = ../../
+
+
+# Compiler flag to set the C Standard level.
+#     c89   = "ANSI" C
+#     gnu89 = c89 plus GCC extensions
+#     c99   = ISO C99 standard (not yet fully implemented)
+#     gnu99 = c99 plus GCC extensions
+CSTANDARD = -std=gnu99
+
+
+# Starting byte address of the bootloader
+BOOT_START = 0x1E000
+
+
+# Place -D or -U options here for C sources
+CDEFS  = -DF_CPU=$(F_CPU)UL -DBOARD=BOARD_$(BOARD) -DUSE_NONSTANDARD_DESCRIPTOR_NAMES -DSTATIC_ENDPOINT_CONFIGURATION
+CDEFS += -DUSB_DEVICE_ONLY -DUSE_STATIC_OPTIONS="(USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL)"
+CDEFS += -DUSE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS -DBOOT_START_ADDR=$(BOOT_START)UL -DFIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE=8 -DUSE_SINGLE_DEVICE_CONFIGURATION
+
+
+# Place -D or -U options here for ASM sources
+ADEFS = -DF_CPU=$(F_CPU)
+
+
+# Place -D or -U options here for C++ sources
+CPPDEFS = -DF_CPU=$(F_CPU)UL
+#CPPDEFS += -D__STDC_LIMIT_MACROS
+#CPPDEFS += -D__STDC_CONSTANT_MACROS
+
+
+
+#---------------- Compiler Options C ----------------
+#  -g*:          generate debugging information
+#  -O*:          optimization level
+#  -f...:        tuning, see GCC manual and avr-libc documentation
+#  -Wall...:     warning level
+#  -Wa,...:      tell GCC to pass this to the assembler.
+#    -adhlns...: create assembler listing
+CFLAGS = -g$(DEBUG)
+CFLAGS += $(CDEFS)
+CFLAGS += -O$(OPT)
+CFLAGS += -funsigned-char
+CFLAGS += -funsigned-bitfields
+CFLAGS += -ffunction-sections
+CFLAGS += -fpack-struct
+CFLAGS += -fshort-enums
+CFLAGS += -fno-inline-small-functions
+CFLAGS += -fno-reorder-blocks
+CFLAGS += -fno-reorder-blocks-and-partition
+CFLAGS += -fno-reorder-functions
+CFLAGS += -fno-toplevel-reorder
+CFLAGS += -Wall
+CFLAGS += -Wstrict-prototypes
+CFLAGS += -Wundef
+#CFLAGS += -fno-unit-at-a-time
+#CFLAGS += -Wunreachable-code
+#CFLAGS += -Wsign-compare
+CFLAGS += -Wa,-adhlns=$(<:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst)
+CFLAGS += $(patsubst %,-I%,$(EXTRAINCDIRS))
+CFLAGS += $(CSTANDARD)
+
+
+#---------------- Compiler Options C++ ----------------
+#  -g*:          generate debugging information
+#  -O*:          optimization level
+#  -f...:        tuning, see GCC manual and avr-libc documentation
+#  -Wall...:     warning level
+#  -Wa,...:      tell GCC to pass this to the assembler.
+#    -adhlns...: create assembler listing
+CPPFLAGS = -g$(DEBUG)
+CPPFLAGS += $(CPPDEFS)
+CPPFLAGS += -O$(OPT)
+CPPFLAGS += -funsigned-char
+CPPFLAGS += -funsigned-bitfields
+CPPFLAGS += -fpack-struct
+CPPFLAGS += -fshort-enums
+CPPFLAGS += -fno-exceptions
+CPPFLAGS += -Wall
+CFLAGS += -Wundef
+#CPPFLAGS += -mshort-calls
+#CPPFLAGS += -fno-unit-at-a-time
+#CPPFLAGS += -Wstrict-prototypes
+#CPPFLAGS += -Wunreachable-code
+#CPPFLAGS += -Wsign-compare
+CPPFLAGS += -Wa,-adhlns=$(<:%.cpp=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst)
+CPPFLAGS += $(patsubst %,-I%,$(EXTRAINCDIRS))
+#CPPFLAGS += $(CSTANDARD)
+
+
+#---------------- Assembler Options ----------------
+#  -Wa,...:   tell GCC to pass this to the assembler.
+#  -adhlns:   create listing
+#  -gstabs:   have the assembler create line number information; note that
+#             for use in COFF files, additional information about filenames
+#             and function names needs to be present in the assembler source
+#             files -- see avr-libc docs [FIXME: not yet described there]
+#  -listing-cont-lines: Sets the maximum number of continuation lines of hex 
+#       dump that will be displayed for a given single line of source input.
+ASFLAGS = $(ADEFS) -Wa,-adhlns=$(<:%.S=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst),-gstabs,--listing-cont-lines=100
+
+
+#---------------- Library Options ----------------
+# Minimalistic printf version
+PRINTF_LIB_MIN = -Wl,-u,vfprintf -lprintf_min
+
+# Floating point printf version (requires MATH_LIB = -lm below)
+PRINTF_LIB_FLOAT = -Wl,-u,vfprintf -lprintf_flt
+
+# If this is left blank, then it will use the Standard printf version.
+PRINTF_LIB = 
+#PRINTF_LIB = $(PRINTF_LIB_MIN)
+#PRINTF_LIB = $(PRINTF_LIB_FLOAT)
+
+
+# Minimalistic scanf version
+SCANF_LIB_MIN = -Wl,-u,vfscanf -lscanf_min
+
+# Floating point + %[ scanf version (requires MATH_LIB = -lm below)
+SCANF_LIB_FLOAT = -Wl,-u,vfscanf -lscanf_flt
+
+# If this is left blank, then it will use the Standard scanf version.
+SCANF_LIB = 
+#SCANF_LIB = $(SCANF_LIB_MIN)
+#SCANF_LIB = $(SCANF_LIB_FLOAT)
+
+
+MATH_LIB = -lm
+
+
+# List any extra directories to look for libraries here.
+#     Each directory must be seperated by a space.
+#     Use forward slashes for directory separators.
+#     For a directory that has spaces, enclose it in quotes.
+EXTRALIBDIRS = 
+
+
+
+#---------------- External Memory Options ----------------
+
+# 64 KB of external RAM, starting after internal RAM (ATmega128!),
+# used for variables (.data/.bss) and heap (malloc()).
+#EXTMEMOPTS = -Wl,-Tdata=0x801100,--defsym=__heap_end=0x80ffff
+
+# 64 KB of external RAM, starting after internal RAM (ATmega128!),
+# only used for heap (malloc()).
+#EXTMEMOPTS = -Wl,--section-start,.data=0x801100,--defsym=__heap_end=0x80ffff
+
+EXTMEMOPTS =
+
+
+
+#---------------- Linker Options ----------------
+#  -Wl,...:     tell GCC to pass this to linker.
+#    -Map:      create map file
+#    --cref:    add cross reference to  map file
+LDFLAGS = -Wl,-Map=$(TARGET).map,--cref
+LDFLAGS += -Wl,--relax
+LDFLAGS += -Wl,--gc-sections
+LDFLAGS += -Wl,--section-start=.text=$(BOOT_START)
+LDFLAGS += $(EXTMEMOPTS)
+LDFLAGS += $(patsubst %,-L%,$(EXTRALIBDIRS))
+LDFLAGS += $(PRINTF_LIB) $(SCANF_LIB) $(MATH_LIB)
+#LDFLAGS += -T linker_script.x
+
+
+
+#---------------- Programming Options (avrdude) ----------------
+
+# Programming hardware: alf avr910 avrisp bascom bsd 
+# dt006 pavr picoweb pony-stk200 sp12 stk200 stk500
+#
+# Type: avrdude -c ?
+# to get a full listing.
+#
+AVRDUDE_PROGRAMMER = jtagmkII
+
+# com1 = serial port. Use lpt1 to connect to parallel port.
+AVRDUDE_PORT = usb
+
+AVRDUDE_WRITE_FLASH = -U flash:w:$(TARGET).hex
+#AVRDUDE_WRITE_EEPROM = -U eeprom:w:$(TARGET).eep
+
+
+# Uncomment the following if you want avrdude's erase cycle counter.
+# Note that this counter needs to be initialized first using -Yn,
+# see avrdude manual.
+#AVRDUDE_ERASE_COUNTER = -y
+
+# Uncomment the following if you do /not/ wish a verification to be
+# performed after programming the device.
+#AVRDUDE_NO_VERIFY = -V
+
+# Increase verbosity level.  Please use this when submitting bug
+# reports about avrdude. See <http://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/avrdude> 
+# to submit bug reports.
+#AVRDUDE_VERBOSE = -v -v
+
+AVRDUDE_FLAGS = -p $(MCU) -P $(AVRDUDE_PORT) -c $(AVRDUDE_PROGRAMMER)
+AVRDUDE_FLAGS += $(AVRDUDE_NO_VERIFY)
+AVRDUDE_FLAGS += $(AVRDUDE_VERBOSE)
+AVRDUDE_FLAGS += $(AVRDUDE_ERASE_COUNTER)
+
+
+
+#---------------- Debugging Options ----------------
+
+# For simulavr only - target MCU frequency.
+DEBUG_MFREQ = $(F_CPU)
+
+# Set the DEBUG_UI to either gdb or insight.
+# DEBUG_UI = gdb
+DEBUG_UI = insight
+
+# Set the debugging back-end to either avarice, simulavr.
+DEBUG_BACKEND = avarice
+#DEBUG_BACKEND = simulavr
+
+# GDB Init Filename.
+GDBINIT_FILE = __avr_gdbinit
+
+# When using avarice settings for the JTAG
+JTAG_DEV = /dev/com1
+
+# Debugging port used to communicate between GDB / avarice / simulavr.
+DEBUG_PORT = 4242
+
+# Debugging host used to communicate between GDB / avarice / simulavr, normally
+#     just set to localhost unless doing some sort of crazy debugging when 
+#     avarice is running on a different computer.
+DEBUG_HOST = localhost
+
+
+
+#============================================================================
+
+
+# Define programs and commands.
+SHELL = sh
+CC = avr-gcc
+OBJCOPY = avr-objcopy
+OBJDUMP = avr-objdump
+SIZE = avr-size
+AR = avr-ar rcs
+NM = avr-nm
+AVRDUDE = avrdude
+REMOVE = rm -f
+REMOVEDIR = rm -rf
+COPY = cp
+WINSHELL = cmd
+
+# Define Messages
+# English
+MSG_ERRORS_NONE = Errors: none
+MSG_BEGIN = -------- begin --------
+MSG_END = --------  end  --------
+MSG_SIZE_BEFORE = Size before: 
+MSG_SIZE_AFTER = Size after:
+MSG_COFF = Converting to AVR COFF:
+MSG_EXTENDED_COFF = Converting to AVR Extended COFF:
+MSG_FLASH = Creating load file for Flash:
+MSG_EEPROM = Creating load file for EEPROM:
+MSG_EXTENDED_LISTING = Creating Extended Listing:
+MSG_SYMBOL_TABLE = Creating Symbol Table:
+MSG_LINKING = Linking:
+MSG_COMPILING = Compiling C:
+MSG_COMPILING_CPP = Compiling C++:
+MSG_ASSEMBLING = Assembling:
+MSG_CLEANING = Cleaning project:
+MSG_CREATING_LIBRARY = Creating library:
+
+
+
+
+# Define all object files.
+OBJ = $(SRC:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.o) $(CPPSRC:%.cpp=$(OBJDIR)/%.o) $(ASRC:%.S=$(OBJDIR)/%.o) 
+
+# Define all listing files.
+LST = $(SRC:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst) $(CPPSRC:%.cpp=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst) $(ASRC:%.S=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst) 
+
+
+# Compiler flags to generate dependency files.
+GENDEPFLAGS = -MMD -MP -MF .dep/$(@F).d
+
+
+# Combine all necessary flags and optional flags.
+# Add target processor to flags.
+ALL_CFLAGS = -mmcu=$(MCU) -I. $(CFLAGS) $(GENDEPFLAGS)
+ALL_CPPFLAGS = -mmcu=$(MCU) -I. -x c++ $(CPPFLAGS) $(GENDEPFLAGS)
+ALL_ASFLAGS = -mmcu=$(MCU) -I. -x assembler-with-cpp $(ASFLAGS)
+
+
+
+
+
+# Default target.
+all: begin gccversion sizebefore build checkhooks checklibmode sizeafter end
+
+# Change the build target to build a HEX file or a library.
+build: elf hex eep lss sym
+#build: lib
+
+
+elf: $(TARGET).elf
+hex: $(TARGET).hex
+eep: $(TARGET).eep
+lss: $(TARGET).lss
+sym: $(TARGET).sym
+LIBNAME=lib$(TARGET).a
+lib: $(LIBNAME)
+
+
+
+# Eye candy.
+# AVR Studio 3.x does not check make's exit code but relies on
+# the following magic strings to be generated by the compile job.
+begin:
+	@echo
+	@echo $(MSG_BEGIN)
+
+end:
+	@echo $(MSG_END)
+	@echo
+
+
+# Display size of file.
+HEXSIZE = $(SIZE) --target=$(FORMAT) $(TARGET).hex
+ELFSIZE = $(SIZE) $(MCU_FLAG) $(FORMAT_FLAG) $(TARGET).elf
+MCU_FLAG = $(shell $(SIZE) --help | grep -- --mcu > /dev/null && echo --mcu=$(MCU) )
+FORMAT_FLAG = $(shell $(SIZE) --help | grep -- --format=.*avr > /dev/null && echo --format=avr )
+
+sizebefore:
+	@if test -f $(TARGET).elf; then echo; echo $(MSG_SIZE_BEFORE); $(ELFSIZE); \
+	2>/dev/null; echo; fi
+
+sizeafter:
+	@if test -f $(TARGET).elf; then echo; echo $(MSG_SIZE_AFTER); $(ELFSIZE); \
+	2>/dev/null; echo; fi
+
+checkhooks: build
+	@echo
+	@echo ------- Unhooked LUFA Events -------
+	@$(shell) (grep -s '^Event.*LUFA/.*\\.o' $(TARGET).map | \
+	           cut -d' ' -f1 | cut -d'_' -f2- | grep ".*") || \
+			   echo "(None)"
+	@echo ----- End Unhooked LUFA Events -----
+	
+checklibmode:
+	@echo
+	@echo ----------- Library Mode -----------
+	@$(shell) ($(CC) $(ALL_CFLAGS) -E -dM - < /dev/null \
+	          | grep 'USB_\(DEVICE\|HOST\)_ONLY' | cut -d' ' -f2 | grep ".*") \
+	          || echo "No specific mode (both device and host mode allowable)."
+	@echo ------------------------------------
+
+# Display compiler version information.
+gccversion : 
+	@$(CC) --version
+
+
+
+# Program the device.  
+program: $(TARGET).hex $(TARGET).eep
+	$(AVRDUDE) $(AVRDUDE_FLAGS) $(AVRDUDE_WRITE_FLASH) $(AVRDUDE_WRITE_EEPROM)
+
+flip: $(TARGET).hex
+	batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation erase f
+	batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation loadbuffer $(TARGET).hex program
+	batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation start reset 0
+
+dfu: $(TARGET).hex
+	dfu-programmer $(MCU) erase
+	dfu-programmer $(MCU) flash --debug 1 $(TARGET).hex
+	dfu-programmer $(MCU) reset
+
+flip-ee: $(TARGET).hex $(TARGET).eep
+	copy $(TARGET).eep $(TARGET)eep.hex
+	batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation memory EEPROM erase
+	batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation memory EEPROM loadbuffer $(TARGET)eep.hex program
+	batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation start reset 0
+
+dfu-ee: $(TARGET).hex $(TARGET).eep
+	dfu-programmer $(MCU) erase
+	dfu-programmer $(MCU) eeprom --debug 1 $(TARGET).eep
+	dfu-programmer $(MCU) reset
+
+# Generate avr-gdb config/init file which does the following:
+#     define the reset signal, load the target file, connect to target, and set 
+#     a breakpoint at main().
+gdb-config: 
+	@$(REMOVE) $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+	@echo define reset >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+	@echo SIGNAL SIGHUP >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+	@echo end >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+	@echo file $(TARGET).elf >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+	@echo target remote $(DEBUG_HOST):$(DEBUG_PORT)  >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+ifeq ($(DEBUG_BACKEND),simulavr)
+	@echo load  >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+endif
+	@echo break main >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+
+debug: gdb-config $(TARGET).elf
+ifeq ($(DEBUG_BACKEND), avarice)
+	@echo Starting AVaRICE - Press enter when "waiting to connect" message displays.
+	@$(WINSHELL) /c start avarice --jtag $(JTAG_DEV) --erase --program --file \
+	$(TARGET).elf $(DEBUG_HOST):$(DEBUG_PORT)
+	@$(WINSHELL) /c pause
+
+else
+	@$(WINSHELL) /c start simulavr --gdbserver --device $(MCU) --clock-freq \
+	$(DEBUG_MFREQ) --port $(DEBUG_PORT)
+endif
+	@$(WINSHELL) /c start avr-$(DEBUG_UI) --command=$(GDBINIT_FILE)
+
+
+
+
+# Convert ELF to COFF for use in debugging / simulating in AVR Studio or VMLAB.
+COFFCONVERT = $(OBJCOPY) --debugging
+COFFCONVERT += --change-section-address .data-0x800000
+COFFCONVERT += --change-section-address .bss-0x800000
+COFFCONVERT += --change-section-address .noinit-0x800000
+COFFCONVERT += --change-section-address .eeprom-0x810000
+
+
+
+coff: $(TARGET).elf
+	@echo
+	@echo $(MSG_COFF) $(TARGET).cof
+	$(COFFCONVERT) -O coff-avr $< $(TARGET).cof
+
+
+extcoff: $(TARGET).elf
+	@echo
+	@echo $(MSG_EXTENDED_COFF) $(TARGET).cof
+	$(COFFCONVERT) -O coff-ext-avr $< $(TARGET).cof
+
+
+
+# Create final output files (.hex, .eep) from ELF output file.
+%.hex: %.elf
+	@echo
+	@echo $(MSG_FLASH) $@
+	$(OBJCOPY) -O $(FORMAT) -R .eeprom $< $@
+
+%.eep: %.elf
+	@echo
+	@echo $(MSG_EEPROM) $@
+	-$(OBJCOPY) -j .eeprom --set-section-flags=.eeprom="alloc,load" \
+	--change-section-lma .eeprom=0 --no-change-warnings -O $(FORMAT) $< $@ || exit 0
+
+# Create extended listing file from ELF output file.
+%.lss: %.elf
+	@echo
+	@echo $(MSG_EXTENDED_LISTING) $@
+	$(OBJDUMP) -h -z -S $< > $@
+
+# Create a symbol table from ELF output file.
+%.sym: %.elf
+	@echo
+	@echo $(MSG_SYMBOL_TABLE) $@
+	$(NM) -n $< > $@
+
+
+
+# Create library from object files.
+.SECONDARY : $(TARGET).a
+.PRECIOUS : $(OBJ)
+%.a: $(OBJ)
+	@echo
+	@echo $(MSG_CREATING_LIBRARY) $@
+	$(AR) $@ $(OBJ)
+
+
+# Link: create ELF output file from object files.
+.SECONDARY : $(TARGET).elf
+.PRECIOUS : $(OBJ)
+%.elf: $(OBJ)
+	@echo
+	@echo $(MSG_LINKING) $@
+	$(CC) $(ALL_CFLAGS) $^ --output $@ $(LDFLAGS)
+
+
+# Compile: create object files from C source files.
+$(OBJDIR)/%.o : %.c
+	@echo
+	@echo $(MSG_COMPILING) $<
+	$(CC) -c $(ALL_CFLAGS) $< -o $@ 
+
+
+# Compile: create object files from C++ source files.
+$(OBJDIR)/%.o : %.cpp
+	@echo
+	@echo $(MSG_COMPILING_CPP) $<
+	$(CC) -c $(ALL_CPPFLAGS) $< -o $@ 
+
+
+# Compile: create assembler files from C source files.
+%.s : %.c
+	$(CC) -S $(ALL_CFLAGS) $< -o $@
+
+
+# Compile: create assembler files from C++ source files.
+%.s : %.cpp
+	$(CC) -S $(ALL_CPPFLAGS) $< -o $@
+
+
+# Assemble: create object files from assembler source files.
+$(OBJDIR)/%.o : %.S
+	@echo
+	@echo $(MSG_ASSEMBLING) $<
+	$(CC) -c $(ALL_ASFLAGS) $< -o $@
+
+
+# Create preprocessed source for use in sending a bug report.
+%.i : %.c
+	$(CC) -E -mmcu=$(MCU) -I. $(CFLAGS) $< -o $@ 
+	
+
+# Target: clean project.
+clean: begin clean_list clean_binary end
+
+clean_binary:
+	$(REMOVE) $(TARGET).hex
+
+clean_list:
+	@echo $(MSG_CLEANING)
+	$(REMOVE) $(TARGET).eep
+	$(REMOVE) $(TARGET).cof
+	$(REMOVE) $(TARGET).elf
+	$(REMOVE) $(TARGET).map
+	$(REMOVE) $(TARGET).sym
+	$(REMOVE) $(TARGET).lss
+	$(REMOVE) $(SRC:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.o)
+	$(REMOVE) $(SRC:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst)
+	$(REMOVE) $(SRC:.c=.s)
+	$(REMOVE) $(SRC:.c=.d)
+	$(REMOVE) $(SRC:.c=.i)
+	$(REMOVEDIR) .dep
+
+
+doxygen:
+	@echo Generating Project Documentation...
+	@doxygen Doxygen.conf
+	@echo Documentation Generation Complete.
+	
+clean_doxygen:
+	rm -rf Documentation
+
+# Create object files directory
+$(shell mkdir $(OBJDIR) 2>/dev/null)
+
+
+# Include the dependency files.
+-include $(shell mkdir .dep 2>/dev/null) $(wildcard .dep/*)
+
+
+# Listing of phony targets.
+.PHONY : all checkhooks checklibmode begin  \
+finish end sizebefore sizeafter gccversion  \
+build elf hex eep lss sym coff extcoff      \
+clean clean_list clean_binary program debug \
+gdb-config doxygen
diff --git a/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.aps b/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.aps
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..4d0f40b7b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.aps
@@ -0,0 +1 @@
+<AVRStudio><MANAGEMENT><ProjectName>BootloaderDFU</ProjectName><Created>30-Sep-2008 14:20:47</Created><LastEdit>30-Sep-2008 14:21:00</LastEdit><ICON>241</ICON><ProjectType>0</ProjectType><Created>30-Sep-2008 14:20:47</Created><Version>4</Version><Build>4, 14, 0, 589</Build><ProjectTypeName>AVR GCC</ProjectTypeName></MANAGEMENT><CODE_CREATION><ObjectFile></ObjectFile><EntryFile></EntryFile><SaveFolder>C:\Users\Dean\Documents\Electronics\Projects\WORK\MyUSBWORK\Bootloaders\DFU\</SaveFolder></CODE_CREATION><DEBUG_TARGET><CURRENT_TARGET></CURRENT_TARGET><CURRENT_PART></CURRENT_PART><BREAKPOINTS></BREAKPOINTS><IO_EXPAND><HIDE>false</HIDE></IO_EXPAND><REGISTERNAMES><Register>R00</Register><Register>R01</Register><Register>R02</Register><Register>R03</Register><Register>R04</Register><Register>R05</Register><Register>R06</Register><Register>R07</Register><Register>R08</Register><Register>R09</Register><Register>R10</Register><Register>R11</Register><Register>R12</Register><Register>R13</Register><Register>R14</Register><Register>R15</Register><Register>R16</Register><Register>R17</Register><Register>R18</Register><Register>R19</Register><Register>R20</Register><Register>R21</Register><Register>R22</Register><Register>R23</Register><Register>R24</Register><Register>R25</Register><Register>R26</Register><Register>R27</Register><Register>R28</Register><Register>R29</Register><Register>R30</Register><Register>R31</Register></REGISTERNAMES><COM></COM><COMType>0</COMType><WATCHNUM>0</WATCHNUM><WATCHNAMES><Pane0></Pane0><Pane1></Pane1><Pane2></Pane2><Pane3></Pane3></WATCHNAMES><BreakOnTrcaeFull>0</BreakOnTrcaeFull></DEBUG_TARGET><Debugger><Triggers></Triggers></Debugger><AVRGCCPLUGIN><FILES><SOURCEFILE>BootloaderDFU.c</SOURCEFILE><SOURCEFILE>Descriptors.c</SOURCEFILE><HEADERFILE>BootloaderDFU.h</HEADERFILE><HEADERFILE>Descriptors.h</HEADERFILE><OTHERFILE>makefile</OTHERFILE></FILES><CONFIGS><CONFIG><NAME>default</NAME><USESEXTERNALMAKEFILE>YES</USESEXTERNALMAKEFILE><EXTERNALMAKEFILE>makefile</EXTERNALMAKEFILE><PART>atmega128</PART><HEX>1</HEX><LIST>1</LIST><MAP>1</MAP><OUTPUTFILENAME>BootloaderDFU.elf</OUTPUTFILENAME><OUTPUTDIR>default\</OUTPUTDIR><ISDIRTY>1</ISDIRTY><OPTIONS/><INCDIRS/><LIBDIRS/><LIBS/><LINKOBJECTS/><OPTIONSFORALL>-Wall -gdwarf-2 -std=gnu99 -Os -funsigned-char -funsigned-bitfields -fpack-struct -fshort-enums</OPTIONSFORALL><LINKEROPTIONS></LINKEROPTIONS><SEGMENTS/></CONFIG></CONFIGS><LASTCONFIG>default</LASTCONFIG><USES_WINAVR>1</USES_WINAVR><GCC_LOC>C:\WinAVR-20080512\bin\avr-gcc.exe</GCC_LOC><MAKE_LOC>C:\WinAVR-20080512\utils\bin\make.exe</MAKE_LOC></AVRGCCPLUGIN><IOView><usergroups/><sort sorted="0" column="0" ordername="0" orderaddress="0" ordergroup="0"/></IOView><Files></Files><Events><Bookmarks></Bookmarks></Events><Trace><Filters></Filters></Trace></AVRStudio>
diff --git a/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.c b/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.c
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..a997b207c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.c
@@ -0,0 +1,692 @@
+/*
+             LUFA Library
+     Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2009.
+              
+  dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+      www.fourwalledcubicle.com
+*/
+
+/*
+  Copyright 2009  Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com)
+
+  Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software
+  and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby
+  granted, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all
+  copies and that both that the copyright notice and this
+  permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting
+  documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in
+  advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
+  software without specific, written prior permission.
+
+  The author disclaim all warranties with regard to this
+  software, including all implied warranties of merchantability
+  and fitness.  In no event shall the author be liable for any
+  special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages
+  whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether
+  in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action,
+  arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of
+  this software.
+*/
+
+/** \file
+ *
+ *  Main source file for the DFU class bootloader. This file contains the complete bootloader logic.
+ */
+ 
+/** Configuration define. Define this token to true to case the bootloader to reject all memory commands
+ *  until a memory erase has been performed. When used in conjunction with the lockbits of the AVR, this
+ *  can protect the AVR's firmware from being dumped from a secured AVR. When false, memory operations are
+ *  allowed at any time.
+ */
+#define SECURE_MODE           false
+
+#define  INCLUDE_FROM_BOOTLOADER_C
+#include "BootloaderDFU.h"
+
+/** Flag to indicate if the bootloader is currently running in secure mode, disallowing memory operations
+ *  other than erase. This is initially set to the value set by SECURE_MODE, and cleared by the bootloader
+ *  once a memory erase has completed.
+ */
+bool IsSecure      = SECURE_MODE;
+
+/** Flag to indicate if the bootloader should be running, or should exit and allow the application code to run
+ *  via a soft reset. When cleared, the bootloader will abort, the USB interface will shut down and the application
+ *  jumped to via an indirect jump to location 0x0000 (or other location specified by the host).
+ */
+bool RunBootloader = true;
+
+/** Flag to indicate if the bootloader is waiting to exit. When the host requests the bootloader to exit and
+ *  jump to the application address it specifies, it sends two sequential commands which must be properly
+ *  acknowedged. Upon reception of the first the RunBootloader flag is cleared and the WaitForExit flag is set,
+ *  causing the bootloader to wait for the final exit command before shutting down.
+ */
+bool WaitForExit = false;
+
+/** Current DFU state machine state, one of the values in the DFU_State_t enum. */
+uint8_t DFU_State = dfuIDLE;
+
+/** Status code of the last executed DFU command. This is set to one of the values in the DFU_Status_t enum after
+ *  each operation, and returned to the host when a Get Status DFU request is issued.
+ */
+uint8_t DFU_Status = OK;
+
+/** Data containing the DFU command sent from the host. */
+DFU_Command_t SentCommand;
+
+/** Response to the last issued Read Data DFU command. Unlike other DFU commands, the read command
+ *  requires a single byte response from the bootloader containing the read data when the next DFU_UPLOAD command
+ *  is issued by the host.
+ */
+uint8_t ResponseByte;
+
+/** Pointer to the start of the user application. By default this is 0x0000 (the reset vector), however the host
+ *  may specify an alternate address when issuing the application soft-start command.
+ */
+AppPtr_t AppStartPtr = (AppPtr_t)0x0000;
+
+/** 64-bit flash page number. This is concatenated with the current 16-bit address on USB AVRs containing more than
+ *  64KB of flash memory.
+ */
+uint8_t Flash64KBPage = 0;
+
+/** Memory start address, indicating the current address in the memory being addressed (either FLASH or EEPROM
+ *  depending on the issued command from the host).
+ */
+uint16_t StartAddr = 0x0000;
+
+/** Memory end address, indicating the end address to read to/write from in the memory being addressed (either FLASH
+ *  of EEPROM depending on the issued command from the host).
+ */
+uint16_t EndAddr = 0x0000;
+
+/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the bootloader, then continuously 
+ *  runs the bootloader processing routine until instructed to soft-exit, or hard-reset via the watchdog to start
+ *  the loaded application code.
+ */
+int main (void)
+{
+	/* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */
+	MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF);
+	wdt_disable();
+
+	/* Disable Clock Division */
+	SetSystemClockPrescaler(0);
+	
+	/* Relocate the interrupt vector table to the bootloader section */
+	MCUCR = (1 << IVCE);
+	MCUCR = (1 << IVSEL);
+
+	/* Initialize the USB subsystem */
+	USB_Init();
+
+	/* Run the USB management task while the bootloader is supposed to be running */
+	while (RunBootloader || WaitForExit)
+	  USB_USBTask();
+	
+	/* Shut down the USB subsystem */
+	USB_ShutDown();
+	
+	/* Relocate the interrupt vector table back to the application section */
+	MCUCR = (1 << IVCE);
+	MCUCR = 0;
+
+	/* Reset any used hardware ports back to their defaults */
+	PORTD = 0;
+	DDRD  = 0;
+	
+	#if defined(PORTE)
+	PORTE = 0;
+	DDRE  = 0;
+	#endif
+	
+	/* Start the user application */
+	AppStartPtr();
+}
+
+/** Event handler for the USB_Disconnect event. This indicates that the bootloader should exit and the user
+ *  application started.
+ */
+EVENT_HANDLER(USB_Disconnect)
+{
+	/* Upon disconnection, run user application */
+	RunBootloader = false;
+}
+
+/** Event handler for the USB_UnhandledControlPacket event. This is used to catch standard and class specific
+ *  control requests that are not handled internally by the USB library (including the DFU commands, which are
+ *  all issued via the control endpoint), so that they can be handled appropriately for the application.
+ */
+EVENT_HANDLER(USB_UnhandledControlPacket)
+{
+	/* Discard unused wIndex value */
+	Endpoint_Discard_Word();
+	
+	/* Discard unused wValue value */
+	Endpoint_Discard_Word();
+
+	/* Get the size of the command and data from the wLength value */
+	SentCommand.DataSize = Endpoint_Read_Word_LE();
+
+	switch (bRequest)
+	{
+		case DFU_DNLOAD:
+			Endpoint_ClearSetupReceived();
+			
+			/* Check if bootloader is waiting to terminate */
+			if (WaitForExit)
+			{
+				/* Bootloader is terminating - process last received command */
+				ProcessBootloaderCommand();
+				
+				/* Indicate that the last command has now been processed - free to exit bootloader */
+				WaitForExit = false;
+			}
+			  
+			/* If the request has a data stage, load it into the command struct */
+			if (SentCommand.DataSize)
+			{
+				while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupOUTReceived()));
+
+				/* First byte of the data stage is the DNLOAD request's command */
+				SentCommand.Command = Endpoint_Read_Byte();
+					
+				/* One byte of the data stage is the command, so subtract it from the total data bytes */
+				SentCommand.DataSize--;
+				
+				/* Load in the rest of the data stage as command parameters */
+				for (uint8_t DataByte = 0; (DataByte < sizeof(SentCommand.Data)) &&
+				     Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint(); DataByte++)
+				{
+					SentCommand.Data[DataByte] = Endpoint_Read_Byte();
+					SentCommand.DataSize--;
+				}
+				
+				/* Process the command */
+				ProcessBootloaderCommand();
+			}
+			
+			/* Check if currently downloading firmware */
+			if (DFU_State == dfuDNLOAD_IDLE)
+			{									
+				if (!(SentCommand.DataSize))
+				{
+					DFU_State = dfuIDLE;
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					/* Throw away the filler bytes before the start of the firmware */
+					DiscardFillerBytes(DFU_FILLER_BYTES_SIZE);
+
+					/* Throw away the page alignment filler bytes before the start of the firmware */
+					DiscardFillerBytes(StartAddr % SPM_PAGESIZE);
+					
+					/* Calculate the number of bytes remaining to be written */
+					uint16_t BytesRemaining = ((EndAddr - StartAddr) + 1);
+					
+					if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x00))        // Write flash
+					{
+						/* Calculate the number of words to be written from the number of bytes to be written */
+						uint16_t WordsRemaining = (BytesRemaining >> 1);
+					
+						union
+						{
+							uint16_t Words[2];
+							uint32_t Long;
+						} CurrFlashAddress                 = {Words: {StartAddr, Flash64KBPage}};
+						
+						uint32_t CurrFlashPageStartAddress = CurrFlashAddress.Long;
+						uint8_t  WordsInFlashPage          = 0;
+
+						while (WordsRemaining--)
+						{
+							/* Check if endpoint is empty - if so clear it and wait until ready for next packet */
+							if (!(Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint()))
+							{
+								Endpoint_ClearSetupOUT();
+								while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupOUTReceived()));
+							}
+
+							/* Write the next word into the current flash page */
+							boot_page_fill(CurrFlashAddress.Long, Endpoint_Read_Word_LE());
+
+							/* Adjust counters */
+							WordsInFlashPage      += 1;
+							CurrFlashAddress.Long += 2;
+
+							/* See if an entire page has been written to the flash page buffer */
+							if ((WordsInFlashPage == (SPM_PAGESIZE >> 1)) || !(WordsRemaining))
+							{
+								/* Commit the flash page to memory */
+								boot_page_write(CurrFlashPageStartAddress);
+								boot_spm_busy_wait();
+								
+								/* Check if programming incomplete */
+								if (WordsRemaining)
+								{
+									CurrFlashPageStartAddress = CurrFlashAddress.Long;
+									WordsInFlashPage          = 0;
+
+									/* Erase next page's temp buffer */
+									boot_page_erase(CurrFlashAddress.Long);
+									boot_spm_busy_wait();
+								}
+							}
+						}
+					
+						/* Once programming complete, start address equals the end address */
+						StartAddr = EndAddr;
+					
+						/* Re-enable the RWW section of flash */
+						boot_rww_enable();
+					}
+					else                                                   // Write EEPROM
+					{
+						while (BytesRemaining--)
+						{
+							/* Check if endpoint is empty - if so clear it and wait until ready for next packet */
+							if (!(Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint()))
+							{
+								Endpoint_ClearSetupOUT();
+								while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupOUTReceived()));
+							}
+
+							/* Read the byte from the USB interface and write to to the EEPROM */
+							eeprom_write_byte((uint8_t*)StartAddr, Endpoint_Read_Byte());
+							
+							/* Adjust counters */
+							StartAddr++;
+						}
+					}
+					
+					/* Throw away the currently unused DFU file suffix */
+					DiscardFillerBytes(DFU_FILE_SUFFIX_SIZE);
+				}
+			}
+
+			Endpoint_ClearSetupOUT();
+
+			/* Send ZLP to the host to acknowedge the request */
+			Endpoint_ClearSetupIN();
+				
+			break;
+		case DFU_UPLOAD:
+			Endpoint_ClearSetupReceived();
+
+			while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupINReady()));
+
+			if (DFU_State != dfuUPLOAD_IDLE)
+			{
+				if ((DFU_State == dfuERROR) && IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x01))       // Blank Check
+				{
+					/* Blank checking is performed in the DFU_DNLOAD request - if we get here we've told the host
+					   that the memory isn't blank, and the host is requesting the first non-blank address */
+					Endpoint_Write_Word_LE(StartAddr);
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					/* Idle state upload - send response to last issued command */
+					Endpoint_Write_Byte(ResponseByte);
+				}
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				/* Determine the number of bytes remaining in the current block */
+				uint16_t BytesRemaining = ((EndAddr - StartAddr) + 1);
+
+				if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x00))            // Read FLASH
+				{
+					/* Calculate the number of words to be written from the number of bytes to be written */
+					uint16_t WordsRemaining = (BytesRemaining >> 1);
+
+					union
+					{
+						uint16_t Words[2];
+						uint32_t Long;
+					} CurrFlashAddress = {Words: {StartAddr, Flash64KBPage}};
+
+					while (WordsRemaining--)
+					{
+						/* Check if endpoint is full - if so clear it and wait until ready for next packet */
+						if (Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint() == FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE)
+						{
+							Endpoint_ClearSetupIN();
+							while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupINReady()));
+						}
+
+						/* Read the flash word and send it via USB to the host */
+						#if defined(RAMPZ)
+							Endpoint_Write_Word_LE(pgm_read_word_far(CurrFlashAddress.Long));
+						#else
+							Endpoint_Write_Word_LE(pgm_read_word(CurrFlashAddress.Long));							
+						#endif
+
+						/* Adjust counters */
+						CurrFlashAddress.Long += 2;
+					}
+					
+					/* Once reading is complete, start address equals the end address */
+					StartAddr = EndAddr;
+				}
+				else if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x02))       // Read EEPROM
+				{
+					while (BytesRemaining--)
+					{
+						/* Check if endpoint is full - if so clear it and wait until ready for next packet */
+						if (Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint() == FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE)
+						{
+							Endpoint_ClearSetupIN();
+							while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupINReady()));
+						}
+
+						/* Read the EEPROM byte and send it via USB to the host */
+						Endpoint_Write_Byte(eeprom_read_byte((uint8_t*)StartAddr));
+
+						/* Adjust counters */
+						StartAddr++;
+					}
+				}
+
+				/* Return to idle state */
+				DFU_State = dfuIDLE;
+			}
+
+			Endpoint_ClearSetupIN();
+
+			/* Send ZLP to the host to acknowedge the request */
+			while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupOUTReceived()));
+			Endpoint_ClearSetupOUT();
+
+			break;
+		case DFU_GETSTATUS:
+			Endpoint_ClearSetupReceived();
+			
+			/* Write 8-bit status value */
+			Endpoint_Write_Byte(DFU_Status);
+			
+			/* Write 24-bit poll timeout value */
+			Endpoint_Write_Byte(0);
+			Endpoint_Write_Word_LE(0);
+			
+			/* Write 8-bit state value */
+			Endpoint_Write_Byte(DFU_State);
+
+			/* Write 8-bit state string ID number */
+			Endpoint_Write_Byte(0);
+
+			Endpoint_ClearSetupIN();
+			
+			while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupOUTReceived()));
+			Endpoint_ClearSetupOUT();
+	
+			break;		
+		case DFU_CLRSTATUS:
+			Endpoint_ClearSetupReceived();
+			
+			/* Reset the status value variable to the default OK status */
+			DFU_Status = OK;
+			
+			Endpoint_ClearSetupIN();
+
+			break;
+		case DFU_GETSTATE:
+			Endpoint_ClearSetupReceived();
+			
+			/* Write the current device state to the endpoint */
+			Endpoint_Write_Byte(DFU_State);
+		
+			Endpoint_ClearSetupIN();
+			
+			while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupOUTReceived()));
+			Endpoint_ClearSetupOUT();
+
+			break;
+		case DFU_ABORT:
+			Endpoint_ClearSetupReceived();
+			
+			/* Reset the current state variable to the default idle state */
+			DFU_State = dfuIDLE;
+			
+			Endpoint_ClearSetupIN();
+
+			break;
+	}
+}
+
+/** Routine to discard the specified number of bytes from the control endpoint stream. This is used to
+ *  discard unused bytes in the stream from the host, including the memory program block suffix.
+ *
+ *  \param NumberOfBytes  Number of bytes to discard from the host from the control endpoint
+ */
+static void DiscardFillerBytes(uint8_t NumberOfBytes)
+{
+	while (NumberOfBytes--)
+	{
+		if (!(Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint()))
+		{
+			Endpoint_ClearSetupOUT();
+
+			/* Wait until next data packet received */
+			while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupOUTReceived()));
+		}
+
+		Endpoint_Discard_Byte();						
+	}
+}
+
+/** Routine to process an issued command from the host, via a DFU_DNLOAD request wrapper. This routine ensures
+ *  that the command is allowed based on the current secure mode flag value, and passes the command off to the
+ *  appropriate handler function.
+ */
+static void ProcessBootloaderCommand(void)
+{
+	/* Check if device is in secure mode */
+	if (IsSecure)
+	{
+		/* Don't process command unless it is a READ or chip erase command */
+		if (!(((SentCommand.Command == COMMAND_WRITE)             &&
+		        IS_TWOBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x00, 0xFF)) ||
+			   (SentCommand.Command == COMMAND_READ)))
+		{
+			/* Set the state and status variables to indicate the error */
+			DFU_State  = dfuERROR;
+			DFU_Status = errWRITE;
+			
+			/* Stall command */
+			Endpoint_StallTransaction();
+			
+			/* Don't process the command */
+			return;
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* Dispatch the required command processing routine based on the command type */
+	switch (SentCommand.Command)
+	{
+		case COMMAND_PROG_START:
+			ProcessMemProgCommand();
+			break;
+		case COMMAND_DISP_DATA:
+			ProcessMemReadCommand();
+			break;
+		case COMMAND_WRITE:
+			ProcessWriteCommand();
+			break;
+		case COMMAND_READ:
+			ProcessReadCommand();
+			break;
+		case COMMAND_CHANGE_BASE_ADDR:
+			if (IS_TWOBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x03, 0x00))              // Set 64KB flash page command
+			  Flash64KBPage = SentCommand.Data[2];
+
+			break;
+	}
+}
+
+/** Routine to concatenate the given pair of 16-bit memory start and end addresses from the host, and store them
+ *  in the StartAddr and EndAddr global variables.
+ */
+static void LoadStartEndAddresses(void)
+{
+	union
+	{
+		uint8_t  Bytes[2];
+		uint16_t Word;
+	} Address[2] = {{Bytes: {SentCommand.Data[2], SentCommand.Data[1]}},
+	                {Bytes: {SentCommand.Data[4], SentCommand.Data[3]}}};
+		
+	/* Load in the start and ending read addresses from the sent data packet */
+	StartAddr = Address[0].Word;
+	EndAddr   = Address[1].Word;
+}
+
+/** Handler for a Memory Program command issued by the host. This routine handles the preperations needed
+ *  to write subsequent data from the host into the specified memory.
+ */
+static void ProcessMemProgCommand(void)
+{
+	if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x00) ||                          // Write FLASH command
+	    IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x01))                            // Write EEPROM command
+	{
+		/* Load in the start and ending read addresses */
+		LoadStartEndAddresses();
+		
+		/* If FLASH is being written to, we need to pre-erase the first page to write to */
+		if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x00))
+		{
+			union
+			{
+				uint16_t Words[2];
+				uint32_t Long;
+			} CurrFlashAddress = {Words: {StartAddr, Flash64KBPage}};
+			
+			/* Erase the current page's temp buffer */
+			boot_page_erase(CurrFlashAddress.Long);
+			boot_spm_busy_wait();
+		}
+		
+		/* Set the state so that the next DNLOAD requests reads in the firmware */
+		DFU_State = dfuDNLOAD_IDLE;
+	}
+}
+
+/** Handler for a Memory Read command issued by the host. This routine handles the preperations needed
+ *  to read subsequent data from the specified memory out to the host, as well as implementing the memory
+ *  blank check command.
+ */
+static void ProcessMemReadCommand(void)
+{
+	if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x00) ||                          // Read FLASH command
+        IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x02))                            // Read EEPROM command
+	{
+		/* Load in the start and ending read addresses */
+		LoadStartEndAddresses();
+
+		/* Set the state so that the next UPLOAD requests read out the firmware */
+		DFU_State = dfuUPLOAD_IDLE;
+	}
+	else if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x01))                       // Blank check FLASH command
+	{
+		uint32_t CurrFlashAddress = 0;
+
+		while (CurrFlashAddress < BOOT_START_ADDR)
+		{
+			/* Check if the current byte is not blank */
+			#if defined(RAMPZ)
+			if (pgm_read_byte_far(CurrFlashAddress) != 0xFF)
+			#else
+			if (pgm_read_byte(CurrFlashAddress) != 0xFF)
+			#endif
+			{
+				/* Save the location of the first non-blank byte for response back to the host */
+				Flash64KBPage = (CurrFlashAddress >> 16);
+				StartAddr     = CurrFlashAddress;
+			
+				/* Set state and status variables to the appropriate error values */
+				DFU_State  = dfuERROR;
+				DFU_Status = errCHECK_ERASED;
+
+				break;
+			}
+
+			CurrFlashAddress++;
+		}
+	}
+}
+
+/** Handler for a Data Write command issued by the host. This routine handles non-programming commands such as
+ *  bootloader exit (both via software jumps and hardware watchdog resets) and flash memory erasure.
+ */
+static void ProcessWriteCommand(void)
+{
+	if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x03))                            // Start application
+	{
+		/* Indicate that the bootloader is terminating */
+		WaitForExit = true;
+
+		/* Check if empty request data array - an empty request after a filled request retains the
+		   previous valid request data, but initializes the reset */
+		if (!(SentCommand.DataSize))
+		{
+			if (SentCommand.Data[1] == 0x00)                                   // Start via watchdog
+			{
+				/* Start the watchdog to reset the AVR once the communications are finalized */
+				wdt_enable(WDTO_250MS);
+			}
+			else                                                               // Start via jump
+			{
+				/* Load in the jump address into the application start address pointer */
+				union
+				{
+					uint8_t  Bytes[2];
+					AppPtr_t FuncPtr;
+				} Address = {Bytes: {SentCommand.Data[4], SentCommand.Data[3]}};
+
+				AppStartPtr = Address.FuncPtr;
+				
+				/* Set the flag to terminate the bootloader at next opportunity */
+				RunBootloader = false;
+			}
+		}
+	}
+	else if (IS_TWOBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x00, 0xFF))                 // Erase flash
+	{
+		uint32_t CurrFlashAddress = 0;
+
+		/* Clear the application section of flash */
+		while (CurrFlashAddress < BOOT_START_ADDR)
+		{
+			boot_page_erase(CurrFlashAddress);
+			boot_spm_busy_wait();
+			boot_page_write(CurrFlashAddress);
+			boot_spm_busy_wait();
+
+			CurrFlashAddress += SPM_PAGESIZE;
+		}
+
+		/* Re-enable the RWW section of flash as writing to the flash locks it out */
+		boot_rww_enable();
+					
+		/* Memory has been erased, reset the security bit so that programming/reading is allowed */
+		IsSecure = false;
+	}
+}
+
+/** Handler for a Data Read command issued by the host. This routine handles bootloader information retrieval
+ *  commands such as device signature and bootloader version retrieval.
+ */
+static void ProcessReadCommand(void)
+{
+	const uint8_t BootloaderInfo[3] = {BOOTLOADER_VERSION, BOOTLOADER_ID_BYTE1, BOOTLOADER_ID_BYTE2};
+	const uint8_t SignatureInfo[3]  = {SIGNATURE_BYTE_1, SIGNATURE_BYTE_2, SIGNATURE_BYTE_3};
+
+	uint8_t DataIndexToRead = SentCommand.Data[1];
+
+	if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x00))                         // Read bootloader info
+	{
+		ResponseByte = BootloaderInfo[DataIndexToRead];
+	}
+	else if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x01))                    // Read signature byte
+	{
+		ResponseByte = SignatureInfo[DataIndexToRead - 0x30];
+	}
+}
diff --git a/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.h b/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.h
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..e5c680d21
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.h
@@ -0,0 +1,199 @@
+/*
+             LUFA Library
+     Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2009.
+              
+  dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+      www.fourwalledcubicle.com
+*/
+
+/*
+  Copyright 2009  Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com)
+
+  Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software
+  and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby
+  granted, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all
+  copies and that both that the copyright notice and this
+  permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting
+  documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in
+  advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
+  software without specific, written prior permission.
+
+  The author disclaim all warranties with regard to this
+  software, including all implied warranties of merchantability
+  and fitness.  In no event shall the author be liable for any
+  special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages
+  whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether
+  in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action,
+  arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of
+  this software.
+*/
+
+/** \file
+ *
+ *  Header file for BootloaderDFU.c.
+ */
+
+#ifndef _BOOTLOADER_H_
+#define _BOOTLOADER_H_
+
+	/* Includes: */
+		#include <avr/io.h>
+		#include <avr/wdt.h>
+		#include <avr/boot.h>
+		#include <avr/eeprom.h>
+		#include <stdbool.h>
+	
+		#include "Descriptors.h"
+		
+		#include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h>                // USB Functionality
+		
+	/* Macros: */
+		/** Major bootloader version number. */
+		#define BOOTLOADER_VERSION_MINOR 2
+
+		/** Minor bootloader version number. */
+		#define BOOTLOADER_VERSION_REV   0
+
+		/** Complete bootloder version number expressed as a packed byte, constructed from the 
+		 *  two individual bootloader version macros.
+		 */
+		#define BOOTLOADER_VERSION       ((BOOTLOADER_VERSION_MINOR << 4) | BOOTLOADER_VERSION_REV)
+
+		/** First byte of the bootloader identification bytes, used to identify a device's bootloader. */
+		#define BOOTLOADER_ID_BYTE1      0xDC
+
+		/** Second byte of the bootloader identification bytes, used to identify a device's bootloader. */
+		#define BOOTLOADER_ID_BYTE2      0xFB
+		
+		/** Convenience macro, used to determine if the issued command is the given one-byte long command.
+		 *
+		 *  \param dataarr  Command byte array to check against
+		 *  \param cb1      First command byte to check
+		 */
+		#define IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(dataarr, cb1)       (dataarr[0] == cb1)
+
+		/** Convenience macro, used to determine if the issued command is the given two-byte long command.
+		 *
+		 *  \param dataarr  Command byte array to check against
+		 *  \param cb1      First command byte to check
+		 *  \param cb2      Second command byte to check
+		 */
+		#define IS_TWOBYTE_COMMAND(dataarr, cb1, cb2) ((dataarr[0] == cb1) && (dataarr[1] == cb2))
+	
+		/** Length of the DFU file suffix block, appended to the end of each complete memory write command.
+		 *  The DFU file suffix is currently unused (but is designed to give extra file information, such as
+		 *  a CRC of the complete firmware for error checking) and so is discarded.
+		 */
+		#define DFU_FILE_SUFFIX_SIZE     16
+
+		/** Length of the DFU file filler block, appended to the start of each complete memory write command.
+		 *  Filler bytes are added to the start of each complete memory write command, and must be discarded.
+		 */
+		#define DFU_FILLER_BYTES_SIZE    26
+	
+		/** DFU class command request to detatch from the host. */
+		#define DFU_DETATCH              0x00
+
+		/** DFU class command request to send data from the host to the bootloader. */
+		#define DFU_DNLOAD               0x01
+
+		/** DFU class command request to send data from the bootloader to the host. */
+		#define DFU_UPLOAD               0x02
+
+		/** DFU class command request to get the current DFU status and state from the bootloader. */
+		#define DFU_GETSTATUS            0x03
+
+		/** DFU class command request to reset the current DFU status and state variables to their defaults. */
+		#define DFU_CLRSTATUS            0x04
+
+		/** DFU class command request to get the current DFU state of the bootloader. */
+		#define DFU_GETSTATE             0x05
+
+		/** DFU class command request to abort the current multi-request transfer and return to the dfuIDLE state. */
+		#define DFU_ABORT                0x06
+
+		/** DFU command to begin programming the device's memory. */
+		#define COMMAND_PROG_START       0x01
+
+		/** DFU command to begin reading the device's memory. */
+		#define COMMAND_DISP_DATA        0x03
+
+		/** DFU command to issue a write command. */
+		#define COMMAND_WRITE            0x04
+
+		/** DFU command to issue a read command. */
+		#define COMMAND_READ             0x05
+
+		/** DFU command to issue a memory base address change command, to set the current 64KB flash page
+		 *  that subsequent flash operations should use. */
+		#define COMMAND_CHANGE_BASE_ADDR 0x06
+
+	/* Type Defines: */
+		/** Type define for a non-returning function pointer to the loaded application. */
+		typedef void (*AppPtr_t)(void) ATTR_NO_RETURN;
+		
+		/** Type define for a strucuture containing a complete DFU command issued by the host. */
+		typedef struct
+		{
+			uint8_t  Command; /**< Single byte command to perform, one of the COMMAND_* macro values */
+			uint8_t  Data[5]; /**< Command parameters */
+			uint16_t DataSize; /**< Size of the command parameters */
+		} DFU_Command_t;
+
+	/* Enums: */
+		/** DFU bootloader states. Refer to the DFU class specification for information on each state. */
+		enum DFU_State_t
+		{
+			appIDLE                      = 0,
+			appDETACH                    = 1,
+			dfuIDLE                      = 2,
+			dfuDNLOAD_SYNC               = 3,
+			dfuDNBUSY                    = 4,
+			dfuDNLOAD_IDLE               = 5,
+			dfuMANIFEST_SYNC             = 6,
+			dfuMANIFEST                  = 7,
+			dfuMANIFEST_WAIT_RESET       = 8,
+			dfuUPLOAD_IDLE               = 9,
+			dfuERROR	                 = 10
+		};
+
+		/** DFU command status error codes. Refer to the DFU class specification for information on each error code. */
+		enum DFU_Status_t
+		{
+			OK                           = 0,
+			errTARGET                    = 1,
+			errFILE                      = 2,
+			errWRITE                     = 3,
+			errERASE                     = 4,
+			errCHECK_ERASED              = 5,
+			errPROG                      = 6,
+			errVERIFY                    = 7,
+			errADDRESS                   = 8,
+			errNOTDONE                   = 9,
+			errFIRMWARE                  = 10,
+			errVENDOR                    = 11,
+			errUSBR                      = 12,
+			errPOR                       = 13,
+			errUNKNOWN                   = 14,
+			errSTALLEDPKT	             = 15
+		};
+		
+	/* Event Handlers: */
+		/** Indicates that this module will catch the USB_Disconnect event when thrown by the library. */
+		HANDLES_EVENT(USB_Disconnect);
+
+		/** Indicates that this module will catch the USB_UnhandledControlPacket event when thrown by the library. */
+		HANDLES_EVENT(USB_UnhandledControlPacket);
+		
+	/* Function Prototypes: */
+		#if defined(INCLUDE_FROM_BOOTLOADER_C)
+			static void DiscardFillerBytes(uint8_t NumberOfBytes);
+			static void ProcessBootloaderCommand(void);
+			static void LoadStartEndAddresses(void);
+			static void ProcessMemProgCommand(void);
+			static void ProcessMemReadCommand(void);
+			static void ProcessWriteCommand(void);
+			static void ProcessReadCommand(void);
+		#endif
+		
+#endif
diff --git a/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.txt b/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.txt
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..091ce4083
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,52 @@
+/** \file
+ *
+ *  This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special
+ *  documentation pages. It is not a project source file.
+ */
+ 
+/** \mainpage DFU Class USB AVR Bootloader
+ *  
+ *  This bootloader enumerates to the host as a DFU Class device, allowing for DFU-compatible programming
+ *  software to load firmware onto the AVR.
+ *  
+ *  This bootloader is compatible with Atmel's FLIP application. However, it requires the use of Atmel's
+ *  DFU drivers. You will need to install Atmel's DFU drivers prior to using this bootloader.
+ *  
+ *  As an open-source option, this bootloader is also compatible with the Linux Atmel USB DFU Programmer
+ *  software, available for download at http://sourceforge.net/projects/dfu-programmer/.
+ *  
+ *  If SECURE_MODE is defined as true, upon startup the bootloader will be locked, with only the chip erase
+ *  function available (similar to Atmel's DFU bootloader). If SECURE_MODE is defined as false, all functions 
+ *  are usable on startup without the prerequisite firmware erase.
+ *  
+ *  Out of the box this bootloader builds for the USB1287, and should fit into 4KB of bootloader space. If
+ *  you wish to enlarge this space and/or change the AVR model, you will need to edit the BOOT_START and MCU
+ *  values in the accompanying makefile.
+ *  
+ *  <b>NOTE:</b> This device spoofs Atmel's DFU Bootloader USB VID and PID so that the Atmel DFU bootloader
+ *               drivers included with FLIP will work. If you do not wish to use Atmel's ID codes, please
+ *               manually change them in Descriptors.c and alter your driver's INF file accordingly.
+ *
+ * <table>
+ *  <tr>
+ *   <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td>
+ *   <td>Device</td>
+ *  </tr>
+ *  <tr>
+ *   <td><b>USB Class:</b></td>
+ *   <td>Device Firmware Update Class (DFU)</td>
+ *  </tr>
+ *  <tr> 
+ *   <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td>
+ *   <td>None</td>
+ *  </tr>
+ *  <tr>
+ *   <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td>
+ *   <td>USBIF DFU Class Standard, Atmel USB Bootloader Datasheet</td>
+ *  </tr>
+ *  <tr>
+ *   <td><b>Usable Speeds:</b></td>
+ *   <td>Full Speed Mode</td>
+ *  </tr>
+ * </table>
+ */
diff --git a/Bootloaders/DFU/Descriptors.c b/Bootloaders/DFU/Descriptors.c
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..3a1c69c73
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Bootloaders/DFU/Descriptors.c
@@ -0,0 +1,181 @@
+/*
+             LUFA Library
+     Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2009.
+              
+  dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+      www.fourwalledcubicle.com
+*/
+
+/*
+  Copyright 2009  Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com)
+
+  Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software
+  and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby
+  granted, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all
+  copies and that both that the copyright notice and this
+  permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting
+  documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in
+  advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
+  software without specific, written prior permission.
+
+  The author disclaim all warranties with regard to this
+  software, including all implied warranties of merchantability
+  and fitness.  In no event shall the author be liable for any
+  special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages
+  whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether
+  in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action,
+  arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of
+  this software.
+*/
+
+/** \file
+ *
+ *  USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special 
+ *  computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine
+ *  the device's capabilities and functions.  
+ */
+
+#include "Descriptors.h"
+
+/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall
+ *  device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the
+ *  number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration
+ *  process begins.
+ */
+USB_Descriptor_Device_t DeviceDescriptor =
+{
+	Header:                 {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), Type: DTYPE_Device},
+		
+	USBSpecification:       VERSION_BCD(01.10),
+	Class:                  0x00,
+	SubClass:               0x00,
+	Protocol:               0x00,
+				
+	Endpoint0Size:          FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE,
+		
+	VendorID:               0x03EB,
+	ProductID:              PRODUCT_ID_CODE,
+	ReleaseNumber:          0x0000,
+		
+	ManufacturerStrIndex:   NO_DESCRIPTOR,
+	ProductStrIndex:        0x01,
+	SerialNumStrIndex:      NO_DESCRIPTOR,
+		
+	NumberOfConfigurations: 1
+};
+
+/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage
+ *  of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces
+ *  and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting
+ *  a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device.
+ */
+USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t ConfigurationDescriptor =
+{
+	Config:
+		{
+			Header:                   {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), Type: DTYPE_Configuration},
+
+			TotalConfigurationSize:   sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t),
+			TotalInterfaces:          1,
+
+			ConfigurationNumber:      1,
+			ConfigurationStrIndex:    NO_DESCRIPTOR,
+				
+			ConfigAttributes:         (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_BUSPOWERED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED),
+			
+			MaxPowerConsumption:      USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100)
+		},
+		
+	DFUInterface:
+		{
+			Header:                 {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), Type: DTYPE_Interface},
+
+			InterfaceNumber:        0,
+			AlternateSetting:       0,
+			
+			TotalEndpoints:         0,
+				
+			Class:                  0xFE,
+			SubClass:               0x01,
+			Protocol:               0x02,
+
+			InterfaceStrIndex:      NO_DESCRIPTOR
+		},
+		
+	DFUFunctional:
+		{
+			Header:                 {Size: sizeof(USB_DFU_Functional_Descriptor_t), Type: DTYPE_DFUFunctional},
+			
+			Attributes:             (ATTR_CAN_UPLOAD | ATTR_CAN_DOWNLOAD),
+
+			DetatchTimeout:         0x0000,
+			TransferSize:           0x0c00,
+		
+			DFUSpecification:       VERSION_BCD(01.01)
+		}
+};
+
+/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests
+ *  the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate
+ *  via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors.
+ */ 
+USB_Descriptor_String_t LanguageString =
+{
+	Header:                 {Size: USB_STRING_LEN(1), Type: DTYPE_String},
+		
+	UnicodeString:          {LANGUAGE_ID_ENG}
+};
+
+/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form,
+ *  and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device
+ *  Descriptor.
+ */
+USB_Descriptor_String_t ProductString =
+{
+	Header:                 {Size: USB_STRING_LEN(18), Type: DTYPE_String},
+		
+	UnicodeString:          L"AVR DFU Bootloader"
+};
+
+/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see StdDescriptors.h
+ *  documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given
+ *  to the USB library. When the device recieves a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function
+ *  is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the
+ *  USB host.
+ */
+uint16_t USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, const uint8_t wIndex, void** const DescriptorAddress)
+{
+	const uint8_t  DescriptorType   = (wValue >> 8);
+	const uint8_t  DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF);
+
+	void*    Address = NULL;
+	uint16_t Size    = NO_DESCRIPTOR;
+
+	switch (DescriptorType)
+	{
+		case DTYPE_Device:
+			Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(DeviceDescriptor);
+			Size    = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t);
+			break;
+		case DTYPE_Configuration:
+			Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(ConfigurationDescriptor);
+			Size    = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t);
+			break;
+		case DTYPE_String:
+			if (!(DescriptorNumber))
+			{
+				Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(LanguageString);
+				Size    = LanguageString.Header.Size;
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(ProductString);
+				Size    = ProductString.Header.Size;
+			}
+			
+			break;
+	}
+	
+	*DescriptorAddress = Address;
+	return Size;
+}
diff --git a/Bootloaders/DFU/Descriptors.h b/Bootloaders/DFU/Descriptors.h
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..b6d1a2af3
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Bootloaders/DFU/Descriptors.h
@@ -0,0 +1,166 @@
+/*
+             LUFA Library
+     Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2009.
+              
+  dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+      www.fourwalledcubicle.com
+*/
+
+/*
+  Copyright 2009  Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com)
+
+  Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software
+  and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby
+  granted, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all
+  copies and that both that the copyright notice and this
+  permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting
+  documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in
+  advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
+  software without specific, written prior permission.
+
+  The author disclaim all warranties with regard to this
+  software, including all implied warranties of merchantability
+  and fitness.  In no event shall the author be liable for any
+  special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages
+  whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether
+  in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action,
+  arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of
+  this software.
+*/
+
+/** \file
+ *
+ *  Header file for Descriptors.c.
+ */
+
+#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_
+#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_
+
+	/* Includes: */
+		#include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h>
+
+	/* Macros: */
+		/** Descriptor type value for a DFU class functional descriptor. */
+		#define DTYPE_DFUFunctional               0x21
+		
+		/** DFU attribute mask, indicating that the DFU device will detach and re-attach when a DFU_DETACH
+		 *  command is issued, rather than the host issing a USB Reset.
+		 */
+		#define ATTR_WILL_DETATCH                 (1 << 3)
+
+		/** DFU attribute mask, indicating that the DFU device can communicate during the manefestation phase
+		 *  (memory programming phase).
+		 */
+		#define ATTR_MANEFESTATION_TOLLERANT      (1 << 2)
+		
+		/** DFU attribute mask, indicating that the DFU device can accept DFU_UPLOAD requests to send data from
+		 *  the device to the host.
+		 */		
+		#define ATTR_CAN_UPLOAD                   (1 << 1)
+
+		/** DFU attribute mask, indicating that the DFU device can accept DFU_DNLOAD requests to send data from
+		 *  the host to the device.
+		 */		
+		#define ATTR_CAN_DOWNLOAD                 (1 << 0)
+
+		#if defined(__AVR_AT90USB1286__)
+			#define PRODUCT_ID_CODE               0x2FFB
+
+			#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_1              0x1E
+			#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_2              0x97
+			#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_3              0x82
+		#elif defined(__AVR_AT90USB1287__)
+			#define PRODUCT_ID_CODE               0x2FFB
+			
+			#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_1              0x1E
+			#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_2              0x97
+			#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_3              0x82
+		#elif defined(__AVR_AT90USB646__)
+			#define PRODUCT_ID_CODE               0x2FF9
+
+			#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_1              0x1E
+			#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_2              0x96
+			#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_3              0x82
+		#elif defined(__AVR_AT90USB647__)
+			#define PRODUCT_ID_CODE               0x2FF9
+
+			#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_1              0x1E
+			#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_2              0x96
+			#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_3              0x82
+		#elif defined(__AVR_AT90USB162__)
+			#define PRODUCT_ID_CODE               0x2FFA
+
+			#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_1              0x1E
+			#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_2              0x94
+			#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_3              0x82
+		#elif defined(__AVR_AT90USB82__)
+			#define PRODUCT_ID_CODE               0x2FF7
+
+			#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_1              0x1E
+			#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_2              0x94
+			#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_3              0x82
+		#elif defined(__AVR_ATmega32U6__)
+			#define PRODUCT_ID_CODE               0x2FFB
+
+			#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_1              0x1E
+			#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_2              0x95
+			#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_3              0x88
+		#elif defined(__AVR_ATmega32U4__)
+			#define PRODUCT_ID_CODE               0x2FF4
+
+			#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_1              0x1E
+			#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_2              0x95
+			#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_3              0x87	
+		#elif defined(__AVR_ATmega16U4__)
+			#define PRODUCT_ID_CODE               0x2FF3
+
+			#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_1              0x1E
+			#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_2              0x94
+			#define SIGNATURE_BYTE_3              0x88
+		#else
+			#error The selected AVR part is not currently supported by this bootloader.
+		#endif
+		
+		#if !defined(PRODUCT_ID_CODE)
+			#error Current AVR model is not supported by this bootloader.
+		#endif
+	
+	/* Type Defines: */
+		/** Type define for a DFU class function descriptor. This descriptor gives DFU class information
+		 *  to the host when read, indicating the DFU device's capabilities.
+		 */
+		typedef struct
+		{
+			USB_Descriptor_Header_t               Header; /**< Standard descriptor header structure */
+			
+			uint8_t                               Attributes; /**< DFU device attributes, a mask comprising of the
+			                                                    *  ATTR_* macros listed in this source file
+			                                                    */
+			uint16_t                              DetatchTimeout; /**< Timeout in milliseconds between a USB_DETACH
+			                                                        *  command being issued and the device detaching
+			                                                        *  from the USB bus
+			                                                        */																	
+			uint16_t                              TransferSize; /**< Maximum number of bytes the DFU device can accept
+			                                                      *  from the host in a transaction
+			                                                      */			
+			uint16_t                              DFUSpecification;	/**< BCD packed DFU specification number this DFU
+			                                                          *  device complies with
+			                                                          */
+		} USB_DFU_Functional_Descriptor_t;
+	
+		/** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the
+		 *  application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which
+		 *  vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host.
+		 */
+		typedef struct
+		{
+			USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config;
+			USB_Descriptor_Interface_t            DFUInterface;
+			USB_DFU_Functional_Descriptor_t       DFUFunctional;
+		} USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t;
+		
+	/* Function Prototypes: */
+		uint16_t USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, const uint8_t wIndex, void** const DescriptorAddress)
+		                           ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3);
+
+#endif
diff --git a/Bootloaders/DFU/Doxygen.conf b/Bootloaders/DFU/Doxygen.conf
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..f78e5fdef
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Bootloaders/DFU/Doxygen.conf
@@ -0,0 +1,1485 @@
+# Doxyfile 1.5.7.1
+
+# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system
+# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project
+#
+# All text after a hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored
+# The format is:
+#       TAG = value [value, ...]
+# For lists items can also be appended using:
+#       TAG += value [value, ...]
+# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (" ")
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# Project related configuration options
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file 
+# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all 
+# text before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the 
+# iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See 
+# http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv for the list of possible encodings.
+
+DOXYFILE_ENCODING      = UTF-8
+
+# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded 
+# by quotes) that should identify the project.
+
+PROJECT_NAME           = "LUFA Library - DFU Class Bootloader"
+
+# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. 
+# This could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or 
+# if some version control system is used.
+
+PROJECT_NUMBER         = 0.0.0
+
+# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) 
+# base path where the generated documentation will be put. 
+# If a relative path is entered, it will be relative to the location 
+# where doxygen was started. If left blank the current directory will be used.
+
+OUTPUT_DIRECTORY       = ./Documentation/
+
+# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES, then doxygen will create 
+# 4096 sub-directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output 
+# format and will distribute the generated files over these directories. 
+# Enabling this option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of 
+# source files, where putting all generated files in the same directory would 
+# otherwise cause performance problems for the file system.
+
+CREATE_SUBDIRS         = YES
+
+# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all 
+# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this 
+# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. 
+# The default language is English, other supported languages are: 
+# Afrikaans, Arabic, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, Chinese-Traditional, 
+# Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, Farsi, Finnish, French, German, Greek, 
+# Hungarian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), 
+# Korean, Korean-en, Lithuanian, Norwegian, Macedonian, Persian, Polish, 
+# Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, Serbian, Serbian-Cyrilic, Slovak, Slovene, 
+# Spanish, Swedish, and Ukrainian.
+
+OUTPUT_LANGUAGE        = English
+
+# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will 
+# include brief member descriptions after the members that are listed in 
+# the file and class documentation (similar to JavaDoc). 
+# Set to NO to disable this.
+
+BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC      = YES
+
+# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will prepend 
+# the brief description of a member or function before the detailed description. 
+# Note: if both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the 
+# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed.
+
+REPEAT_BRIEF           = YES
+
+# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator 
+# that is used to form the text in various listings. Each string 
+# in this list, if found as the leading text of the brief description, will be 
+# stripped from the text and the result after processing the whole list, is 
+# used as the annotated text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. 
+# If left blank, the following values are used ("$name" is automatically 
+# replaced with the name of the entity): "The $name class" "The $name widget" 
+# "The $name file" "is" "provides" "specifies" "contains" 
+# "represents" "a" "an" "the"
+
+ABBREVIATE_BRIEF       = "The $name class" \
+                         "The $name widget" \
+                         "The $name file" \
+                         is \
+                         provides \
+                         specifies \
+                         contains \
+                         represents \
+                         a \
+                         an \
+                         the
+
+# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then 
+# Doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief 
+# description.
+
+ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC    = NO
+
+# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all 
+# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those 
+# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment 
+# operators of the base classes will not be shown.
+
+INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB  = NO
+
+# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES then Doxygen will prepend the full 
+# path before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set 
+# to NO the shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used.
+
+FULL_PATH_NAMES        = YES
+
+# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES then the STRIP_FROM_PATH tag 
+# can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. Stripping is 
+# only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand part of 
+# the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. 
+# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the 
+# path to strip.
+
+STRIP_FROM_PATH        = 
+
+# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of 
+# the path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells 
+# the reader which header file to include in order to use a class. 
+# If left blank only the name of the header file containing the class 
+# definition is used. Otherwise one should specify the include paths that 
+# are normally passed to the compiler using the -I flag.
+
+STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH    = 
+
+# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter 
+# (but less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems 
+# doesn't support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM.
+
+SHORT_NAMES            = YES
+
+# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then Doxygen 
+# will interpret the first line (until the first dot) of a JavaDoc-style 
+# comment as the brief description. If set to NO, the JavaDoc 
+# comments will behave just like regular Qt-style comments 
+# (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief description.)
+
+JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF      = NO
+
+# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then Doxygen will 
+# interpret the first line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style 
+# comment as the brief description. If set to NO, the comments 
+# will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus requiring 
+# an explicit \brief command for a brief description.)
+
+QT_AUTOBRIEF           = NO
+
+# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make Doxygen 
+# treat a multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// 
+# comments) as a brief description. This used to be the default behaviour. 
+# The new default is to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed 
+# description. Set this tag to YES if you prefer the old behaviour instead.
+
+MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO
+
+# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES (the default) then an undocumented 
+# member inherits the documentation from any documented member that it 
+# re-implements.
+
+INHERIT_DOCS           = YES
+
+# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES, then doxygen will produce 
+# a new page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will 
+# be part of the file/class/namespace that contains it.
+
+SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES  = NO
+
+# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. 
+# Doxygen uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments.
+
+TAB_SIZE               = 4
+
+# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that acts 
+# as commands in the documentation. An alias has the form "name=value". 
+# For example adding "sideeffect=\par Side Effects:\n" will allow you to 
+# put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the documentation, which 
+# will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading "Side Effects:". 
+# You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert newlines.
+
+ALIASES                = 
+
+# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C 
+# sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. 
+# For instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list 
+# of all members will be omitted, etc.
+
+OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C  = YES
+
+# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java 
+# sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for 
+# Java. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, qualified 
+# scopes will look different, etc.
+
+OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA   = NO
+
+# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran 
+# sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for 
+# Fortran.
+
+OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN   = NO
+
+# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL 
+# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for 
+# VHDL.
+
+OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL   = NO
+
+# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want 
+# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should 
+# set this tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and 
+# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); v.s. 
+# func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration 
+# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate.
+
+BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT    = NO
+
+# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to
+# enable parsing support.
+
+CPP_CLI_SUPPORT        = NO
+
+# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip sources only. 
+# Doxygen will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public 
+# instead of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present.
+
+SIP_SUPPORT            = NO
+
+# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate getter 
+# and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES (the default) 
+# will make doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the 
+# documentation. This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or 
+# setting a simple type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the 
+# methods anyway, you should set this option to NO.
+
+IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT   = YES
+
+# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC 
+# tag is set to YES, then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first 
+# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default 
+# all members of a group must be documented explicitly.
+
+DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC   = NO
+
+# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES (the default) to allow class member groups of 
+# the same type (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a 
+# subgroup of that type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to 
+# NO to prevent subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using 
+# the \nosubgrouping command.
+
+SUBGROUPING            = YES
+
+# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or enum 
+# is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So 
+# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct 
+# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, 
+# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically 
+# be useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound 
+# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name.
+
+TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT   = NO
+
+# The SYMBOL_CACHE_SIZE determines the size of the internal cache use to 
+# determine which symbols to keep in memory and which to flush to disk.
+# When the cache is full, less often used symbols will be written to disk.
+# For small to medium size projects (<1000 input files) the default value is 
+# probably good enough. For larger projects a too small cache size can cause 
+# doxygen to be busy swapping symbols to and from disk most of the time 
+# causing a significant performance penality. 
+# If the system has enough physical memory increasing the cache will improve the 
+# performance by keeping more symbols in memory. Note that the value works on 
+# a logarithmic scale so increasing the size by one will rougly double the 
+# memory usage. The cache size is given by this formula: 
+# 2^(16+SYMBOL_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range is 0..9, the default is 0, 
+# corresponding to a cache size of 2^16 = 65536 symbols
+
+SYMBOL_CACHE_SIZE      = 0
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# Build related configuration options
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES doxygen will assume all entities in 
+# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. 
+# Private class members and static file members will be hidden unless 
+# the EXTRACT_PRIVATE and EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES
+
+EXTRACT_ALL            = YES
+
+# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES all private members of a class 
+# will be included in the documentation.
+
+EXTRACT_PRIVATE        = YES
+
+# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES all static members of a file 
+# will be included in the documentation.
+
+EXTRACT_STATIC         = YES
+
+# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES classes (and structs) 
+# defined locally in source files will be included in the documentation. 
+# If set to NO only classes defined in header files are included.
+
+EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES  = YES
+
+# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. When set to YES local 
+# methods, which are defined in the implementation section but not in 
+# the interface are included in the documentation. 
+# If set to NO (the default) only methods in the interface are included.
+
+EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS  = NO
+
+# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be 
+# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called 
+# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base 
+# name of the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default 
+# anonymous namespace are hidden.
+
+EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES   = NO
+
+# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, Doxygen will hide all 
+# undocumented members of documented classes, files or namespaces. 
+# If set to NO (the default) these members will be included in the 
+# various overviews, but no documentation section is generated. 
+# This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled.
+
+HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS     = NO
+
+# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, Doxygen will hide all 
+# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. 
+# If set to NO (the default) these classes will be included in the various 
+# overviews. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled.
+
+HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES     = NO
+
+# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, Doxygen will hide all 
+# friend (class|struct|union) declarations. 
+# If set to NO (the default) these declarations will be included in the 
+# documentation.
+
+HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS  = NO
+
+# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, Doxygen will hide any 
+# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. 
+# If set to NO (the default) these blocks will be appended to the 
+# function's detailed documentation block.
+
+HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS      = NO
+
+# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation 
+# that is typed after a \internal command is included. If the tag is set 
+# to NO (the default) then the documentation will be excluded. 
+# Set it to YES to include the internal documentation.
+
+INTERNAL_DOCS          = NO
+
+# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then Doxygen will only generate 
+# file names in lower-case letters. If set to YES upper-case letters are also 
+# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ 
+# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows 
+# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO.
+
+CASE_SENSE_NAMES       = NO
+
+# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO (the default) then Doxygen 
+# will show members with their full class and namespace scopes in the 
+# documentation. If set to YES the scope will be hidden.
+
+HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES       = NO
+
+# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES (the default) then Doxygen 
+# will put a list of the files that are included by a file in the documentation 
+# of that file.
+
+SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES     = YES
+
+# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES (the default) then a tag [inline] 
+# is inserted in the documentation for inline members.
+
+INLINE_INFO            = YES
+
+# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES (the default) then doxygen 
+# will sort the (detailed) documentation of file and class members 
+# alphabetically by member name. If set to NO the members will appear in 
+# declaration order.
+
+SORT_MEMBER_DOCS       = YES
+
+# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the 
+# brief documentation of file, namespace and class members alphabetically 
+# by member name. If set to NO (the default) the members will appear in 
+# declaration order.
+
+SORT_BRIEF_DOCS        = NO
+
+# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the 
+# hierarchy of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO (the default) 
+# the group names will appear in their defined order.
+
+SORT_GROUP_NAMES       = NO
+
+# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be 
+# sorted by fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to 
+# NO (the default), the class list will be sorted only by class name, 
+# not including the namespace part. 
+# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES.
+# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the 
+# alphabetical list.
+
+SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME     = NO
+
+# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or 
+# disable (NO) the todo list. This list is created by putting \todo 
+# commands in the documentation.
+
+GENERATE_TODOLIST      = NO
+
+# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or 
+# disable (NO) the test list. This list is created by putting \test 
+# commands in the documentation.
+
+GENERATE_TESTLIST      = NO
+
+# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or 
+# disable (NO) the bug list. This list is created by putting \bug 
+# commands in the documentation.
+
+GENERATE_BUGLIST       = NO
+
+# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or 
+# disable (NO) the deprecated list. This list is created by putting 
+# \deprecated commands in the documentation.
+
+GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES
+
+# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional 
+# documentation sections, marked by \if sectionname ... \endif.
+
+ENABLED_SECTIONS       = 
+
+# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines 
+# the initial value of a variable or define consists of for it to appear in 
+# the documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified 
+# here it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. 
+# The appearance of the initializer of individual variables and defines in the 
+# documentation can be controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer 
+# command in the documentation regardless of this setting.
+
+MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES  = 30
+
+# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated 
+# at the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES the 
+# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation.
+
+SHOW_USED_FILES        = YES
+
+# If the sources in your project are distributed over multiple directories 
+# then setting the SHOW_DIRECTORIES tag to YES will show the directory hierarchy 
+# in the documentation. The default is NO.
+
+SHOW_DIRECTORIES       = YES
+
+# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page.
+# This will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the 
+# Folder Tree View (if specified). The default is YES.
+
+SHOW_FILES             = YES
+
+# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the 
+# Namespaces page.  This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index
+# and from the Folder Tree View (if specified). The default is YES.
+
+SHOW_NAMESPACES        = YES
+
+# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that 
+# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from 
+# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via 
+# popen()) the command <command> <input-file>, where <command> is the value of 
+# the FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the name of an input file 
+# provided by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output 
+# is used as the file version. See the manual for examples.
+
+FILE_VERSION_FILTER    = 
+
+# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed by 
+# doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated output files 
+# in an output format independent way. The create the layout file that represents 
+# doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can optionally specify a 
+# file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml will be used as the name 
+# of the layout file.
+
+LAYOUT_FILE            = 
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to warning and progress messages
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated 
+# by doxygen. Possible values are YES and NO. If left blank NO is used.
+
+QUIET                  = YES
+
+# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are 
+# generated by doxygen. Possible values are YES and NO. If left blank 
+# NO is used.
+
+WARNINGS               = YES
+
+# If WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED is set to YES, then doxygen will generate warnings 
+# for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag will 
+# automatically be disabled.
+
+WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED   = YES
+
+# If WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for 
+# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some 
+# parameters in a documented function, or documenting parameters that 
+# don't exist or using markup commands wrongly.
+
+WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR      = YES
+
+# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be abled to get warnings for 
+# functions that are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters 
+# or return value. If set to NO (the default) doxygen will only warn about 
+# wrong or incomplete parameter documentation, but not about the absence of 
+# documentation.
+
+WARN_NO_PARAMDOC       = YES
+
+# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that 
+# doxygen can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text 
+# tags, which will be replaced by the file and line number from which the 
+# warning originated and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain 
+# $version, which will be replaced by the version of the file (if it could 
+# be obtained via FILE_VERSION_FILTER)
+
+WARN_FORMAT            = "$file:$line: $text"
+
+# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning 
+# and error messages should be written. If left blank the output is written 
+# to stderr.
+
+WARN_LOGFILE           = 
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the input files
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# The INPUT tag can be used to specify the files and/or directories that contain 
+# documented source files. You may enter file names like "myfile.cpp" or 
+# directories like "/usr/src/myproject". Separate the files or directories 
+# with spaces.
+
+INPUT                  = ./
+
+# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files 
+# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding, which is 
+# also the default input encoding. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv built 
+# into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv for 
+# the list of possible encodings.
+
+INPUT_ENCODING         = UTF-8
+
+# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the 
+# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp 
+# and *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left 
+# blank the following patterns are tested: 
+# *.c *.cc *.cxx *.cpp *.c++ *.java *.ii *.ixx *.ipp *.i++ *.inl *.h *.hh *.hxx 
+# *.hpp *.h++ *.idl *.odl *.cs *.php *.php3 *.inc *.m *.mm *.py *.f90
+
+FILE_PATTERNS          = *.h \
+                         *.c \
+						 *.txt
+
+# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to turn specify whether or not subdirectories 
+# should be searched for input files as well. Possible values are YES and NO. 
+# If left blank NO is used.
+
+RECURSIVE              = YES
+
+# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should 
+# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a 
+# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag.
+
+EXCLUDE                = 
+
+# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used select whether or not files or 
+# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix filesystem feature) are excluded 
+# from the input.
+
+EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS       = NO
+
+# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the 
+# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude 
+# certain files from those directories. Note that the wildcards are matched 
+# against the file with absolute path, so to exclude all test directories 
+# for example use the pattern */test/*
+
+EXCLUDE_PATTERNS       = */LowLevel/USBMode.h
+
+# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names 
+# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the 
+# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the 
+# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, 
+# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test
+
+EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS        = __*
+
+# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or 
+# directories that contain example code fragments that are included (see 
+# the \include command).
+
+EXAMPLE_PATH           = 
+
+# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the 
+# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp 
+# and *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left 
+# blank all files are included.
+
+EXAMPLE_PATTERNS       = *
+
+# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be 
+# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude 
+# commands irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. 
+# Possible values are YES and NO. If left blank NO is used.
+
+EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE      = NO
+
+# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or 
+# directories that contain image that are included in the documentation (see 
+# the \image command).
+
+IMAGE_PATH             = 
+
+# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should 
+# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program 
+# by executing (via popen()) the command <filter> <input-file>, where <filter> 
+# is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the name of an 
+# input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter program writes 
+# to standard output.  If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag will be 
+# ignored.
+
+INPUT_FILTER           = 
+
+# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern 
+# basis.  Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the 
+# filter if there is a match.  The filters are a list of the form: 
+# pattern=filter (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further 
+# info on how filters are used. If FILTER_PATTERNS is empty, INPUT_FILTER 
+# is applied to all files.
+
+FILTER_PATTERNS        = 
+
+# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using 
+# INPUT_FILTER) will be used to filter the input files when producing source 
+# files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES).
+
+FILTER_SOURCE_FILES    = NO
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to source browsing
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will 
+# be generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. 
+# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure also 
+# VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO.
+
+SOURCE_BROWSER         = NO
+
+# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body 
+# of functions and classes directly in the documentation.
+
+INLINE_SOURCES         = NO
+
+# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES (the default) will instruct 
+# doxygen to hide any special comment blocks from generated source code 
+# fragments. Normal C and C++ comments will always remain visible.
+
+STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS    = YES
+
+# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES 
+# then for each documented function all documented 
+# functions referencing it will be listed.
+
+REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO
+
+# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES 
+# then for each documented function all documented entities 
+# called/used by that function will be listed.
+
+REFERENCES_RELATION    = NO
+
+# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES (the default)
+# and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES, then the hyperlinks from
+# functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will
+# link to the source code.  Otherwise they will link to the documentstion.
+
+REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO
+
+# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code 
+# will point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen 
+# built-in source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source 
+# tagging system (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You 
+# will need version 4.8.6 or higher.
+
+USE_HTAGS              = NO
+
+# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set to YES (the default) then Doxygen 
+# will generate a verbatim copy of the header file for each class for 
+# which an include is specified. Set to NO to disable this.
+
+VERBATIM_HEADERS       = NO
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the alphabetical class index
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index 
+# of all compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project 
+# contains a lot of classes, structs, unions or interfaces.
+
+ALPHABETICAL_INDEX     = YES
+
+# If the alphabetical index is enabled (see ALPHABETICAL_INDEX) then 
+# the COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns 
+# in which this list will be split (can be a number in the range [1..20])
+
+COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX    = 5
+
+# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all 
+# classes will be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. 
+# The IGNORE_PREFIX tag can be used to specify one or more prefixes that 
+# should be ignored while generating the index headers.
+
+IGNORE_PREFIX          = 
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the HTML output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will 
+# generate HTML output.
+
+GENERATE_HTML          = YES
+
+# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. 
+# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be 
+# put in front of it. If left blank `html' will be used as the default path.
+
+HTML_OUTPUT            = html
+
+# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for 
+# each generated HTML page (for example: .htm,.php,.asp). If it is left blank 
+# doxygen will generate files with .html extension.
+
+HTML_FILE_EXTENSION    = .html
+
+# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal HTML header for 
+# each generated HTML page. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a 
+# standard header.
+
+HTML_HEADER            = 
+
+# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal HTML footer for 
+# each generated HTML page. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a 
+# standard footer.
+
+HTML_FOOTER            = 
+
+# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading 
+# style sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to 
+# fine-tune the look of the HTML output. If the tag is left blank doxygen 
+# will generate a default style sheet. Note that doxygen will try to copy 
+# the style sheet file to the HTML output directory, so don't put your own 
+# stylesheet in the HTML output directory as well, or it will be erased!
+
+HTML_STYLESHEET        = 
+
+# If the HTML_ALIGN_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, the members of classes, 
+# files or namespaces will be aligned in HTML using tables. If set to 
+# NO a bullet list will be used.
+
+HTML_ALIGN_MEMBERS     = YES
+
+# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML 
+# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the 
+# page has loaded. For this to work a browser that supports 
+# JavaScript and DHTML is required (for instance Mozilla 1.0+, Firefox 
+# Netscape 6.0+, Internet explorer 5.0+, Konqueror, or Safari).
+
+HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS  = YES
+
+# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files 
+# will be generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 
+# integrated development environment, introduced with OSX 10.5 (Leopard). 
+# To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a Makefile in the 
+# HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in that 
+# directory and running "make install" will install the docset in 
+# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find 
+# it at startup. 
+# See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html for more information.
+
+GENERATE_DOCSET        = NO
+
+# When GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, this tag determines the name of the 
+# feed. A documentation feed provides an umbrella under which multiple 
+# documentation sets from a single provider (such as a company or product suite) 
+# can be grouped.
+
+DOCSET_FEEDNAME        = "Doxygen generated docs"
+
+# When GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, this tag specifies a string that 
+# should uniquely identify the documentation set bundle. This should be a 
+# reverse domain-name style string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen 
+# will append .docset to the name.
+
+DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID       = org.doxygen.Project
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files 
+# will be generated that can be used as input for tools like the 
+# Microsoft HTML help workshop to generate a compiled HTML help file (.chm) 
+# of the generated HTML documentation.
+
+GENERATE_HTMLHELP      = NO
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the CHM_FILE tag can 
+# be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm file. You 
+# can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be 
+# written to the html output directory.
+
+CHM_FILE               = 
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the HHC_LOCATION tag can 
+# be used to specify the location (absolute path including file name) of 
+# the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty doxygen will try to run 
+# the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp.
+
+HHC_LOCATION           = 
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the GENERATE_CHI flag 
+# controls if a separate .chi index file is generated (YES) or that 
+# it should be included in the master .chm file (NO).
+
+GENERATE_CHI           = NO
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the CHM_INDEX_ENCODING
+# is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) and project file
+# content.
+
+CHM_INDEX_ENCODING     = 
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the BINARY_TOC flag 
+# controls whether a binary table of contents is generated (YES) or a 
+# normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file.
+
+BINARY_TOC             = NO
+
+# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members 
+# to the contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view.
+
+TOC_EXPAND             = YES
+
+# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER 
+# are set, an additional index file will be generated that can be used as input for 
+# Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help (.qch) of the generated 
+# HTML documentation.
+
+GENERATE_QHP           = NO
+
+# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can 
+# be used to specify the file name of the resulting .qch file. 
+# The path specified is relative to the HTML output folder.
+
+QCH_FILE               = 
+
+# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating 
+# Qt Help Project output. For more information please see 
+# <a href="http://doc.trolltech.com/qthelpproject.html#namespace">Qt Help Project / Namespace</a>.
+
+QHP_NAMESPACE          = org.doxygen.Project
+
+# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating 
+# Qt Help Project output. For more information please see 
+# <a href="http://doc.trolltech.com/qthelpproject.html#virtual-folders">Qt Help Project / Virtual Folders</a>.
+
+QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER     = doc
+
+# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES, the QHG_LOCATION tag can 
+# be used to specify the location of Qt's qhelpgenerator. 
+# If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the generated 
+# .qhp file .
+
+QHG_LOCATION           = 
+
+# The DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index at 
+# top of each HTML page. The value NO (the default) enables the index and 
+# the value YES disables it.
+
+DISABLE_INDEX          = NO
+
+# This tag can be used to set the number of enum values (range [1..20]) 
+# that doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation.
+
+ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE   = 1
+
+# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index
+# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information.
+# If the tag value is set to FRAME, a side panel will be generated
+# containing a tree-like index structure (just like the one that 
+# is generated for HTML Help). For this to work a browser that supports 
+# JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required (for instance Mozilla 1.0+, 
+# Netscape 6.0+, Internet explorer 5.0+, or Konqueror). Windows users are 
+# probably better off using the HTML help feature. Other possible values 
+# for this tag are: HIERARCHIES, which will generate the Groups, Directories,
+# and Class Hierarchy pages using a tree view instead of an ordered list;
+# ALL, which combines the behavior of FRAME and HIERARCHIES; and NONE, which
+# disables this behavior completely. For backwards compatibility with previous
+# releases of Doxygen, the values YES and NO are equivalent to FRAME and NONE
+# respectively.
+
+GENERATE_TREEVIEW      = YES
+
+# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be 
+# used to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree 
+# is shown.
+
+TREEVIEW_WIDTH         = 250
+
+# Use this tag to change the font size of Latex formulas included 
+# as images in the HTML documentation. The default is 10. Note that 
+# when you change the font size after a successful doxygen run you need 
+# to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML output directory 
+# to force them to be regenerated.
+
+FORMULA_FONTSIZE       = 10
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the LaTeX output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will 
+# generate Latex output.
+
+GENERATE_LATEX         = NO
+
+# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. 
+# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be 
+# put in front of it. If left blank `latex' will be used as the default path.
+
+LATEX_OUTPUT           = latex
+
+# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be 
+# invoked. If left blank `latex' will be used as the default command name.
+
+LATEX_CMD_NAME         = latex
+
+# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to 
+# generate index for LaTeX. If left blank `makeindex' will be used as the 
+# default command name.
+
+MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME     = makeindex
+
+# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES Doxygen generates more compact 
+# LaTeX documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to 
+# save some trees in general.
+
+COMPACT_LATEX          = NO
+
+# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used 
+# by the printer. Possible values are: a4, a4wide, letter, legal and 
+# executive. If left blank a4wide will be used.
+
+PAPER_TYPE             = a4wide
+
+# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be to specify one or more names of LaTeX 
+# packages that should be included in the LaTeX output.
+
+EXTRA_PACKAGES         = 
+
+# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for 
+# the generated latex document. The header should contain everything until 
+# the first chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a 
+# standard header. Notice: only use this tag if you know what you are doing!
+
+LATEX_HEADER           = 
+
+# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated 
+# is prepared for conversion to pdf (using ps2pdf). The pdf file will 
+# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references 
+# This makes the output suitable for online browsing using a pdf viewer.
+
+PDF_HYPERLINKS         = YES
+
+# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, pdflatex will be used instead of 
+# plain latex in the generated Makefile. Set this option to YES to get a 
+# higher quality PDF documentation.
+
+USE_PDFLATEX           = YES
+
+# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \\batchmode. 
+# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep 
+# running if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. 
+# This option is also used when generating formulas in HTML.
+
+LATEX_BATCHMODE        = NO
+
+# If LATEX_HIDE_INDICES is set to YES then doxygen will not 
+# include the index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) 
+# in the output.
+
+LATEX_HIDE_INDICES     = NO
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the RTF output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES Doxygen will generate RTF output 
+# The RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look very pretty with 
+# other RTF readers or editors.
+
+GENERATE_RTF           = NO
+
+# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. 
+# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be 
+# put in front of it. If left blank `rtf' will be used as the default path.
+
+RTF_OUTPUT             = rtf
+
+# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES Doxygen generates more compact 
+# RTF documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to 
+# save some trees in general.
+
+COMPACT_RTF            = NO
+
+# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated 
+# will contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will 
+# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. 
+# This makes the output suitable for online browsing using WORD or other 
+# programs which support those fields. 
+# Note: wordpad (write) and others do not support links.
+
+RTF_HYPERLINKS         = NO
+
+# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's 
+# config file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide 
+# replacements, missing definitions are set to their default value.
+
+RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE    = 
+
+# Set optional variables used in the generation of an rtf document. 
+# Syntax is similar to doxygen's config file.
+
+RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE    = 
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the man page output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will 
+# generate man pages
+
+GENERATE_MAN           = NO
+
+# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. 
+# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be 
+# put in front of it. If left blank `man' will be used as the default path.
+
+MAN_OUTPUT             = man
+
+# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to 
+# the generated man pages (default is the subroutine's section .3)
+
+MAN_EXTENSION          = .3
+
+# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and Doxygen generates man output, 
+# then it will generate one additional man file for each entity 
+# documented in the real man page(s). These additional files 
+# only source the real man page, but without them the man command 
+# would be unable to find the correct page. The default is NO.
+
+MAN_LINKS              = NO
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the XML output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES Doxygen will 
+# generate an XML file that captures the structure of 
+# the code including all documentation.
+
+GENERATE_XML           = NO
+
+# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. 
+# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be 
+# put in front of it. If left blank `xml' will be used as the default path.
+
+XML_OUTPUT             = xml
+
+# The XML_SCHEMA tag can be used to specify an XML schema, 
+# which can be used by a validating XML parser to check the 
+# syntax of the XML files.
+
+XML_SCHEMA             = 
+
+# The XML_DTD tag can be used to specify an XML DTD, 
+# which can be used by a validating XML parser to check the 
+# syntax of the XML files.
+
+XML_DTD                = 
+
+# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES Doxygen will 
+# dump the program listings (including syntax highlighting 
+# and cross-referencing information) to the XML output. Note that 
+# enabling this will significantly increase the size of the XML output.
+
+XML_PROGRAMLISTING     = YES
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES Doxygen will 
+# generate an AutoGen Definitions (see autogen.sf.net) file 
+# that captures the structure of the code including all 
+# documentation. Note that this feature is still experimental 
+# and incomplete at the moment.
+
+GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF   = NO
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the Perl module output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES Doxygen will 
+# generate a Perl module file that captures the structure of 
+# the code including all documentation. Note that this 
+# feature is still experimental and incomplete at the 
+# moment.
+
+GENERATE_PERLMOD       = NO
+
+# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES Doxygen will generate 
+# the necessary Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able 
+# to generate PDF and DVI output from the Perl module output.
+
+PERLMOD_LATEX          = NO
+
+# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES the Perl module output will be 
+# nicely formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader.  This is useful 
+# if you want to understand what is going on.  On the other hand, if this 
+# tag is set to NO the size of the Perl module output will be much smaller 
+# and Perl will parse it just the same.
+
+PERLMOD_PRETTY         = YES
+
+# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file 
+# are prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. 
+# This is useful so different doxyrules.make files included by the same 
+# Makefile don't overwrite each other's variables.
+
+PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = 
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# Configuration options related to the preprocessor   
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will 
+# evaluate all C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include 
+# files.
+
+ENABLE_PREPROCESSING   = YES
+
+# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES Doxygen will expand all macro 
+# names in the source code. If set to NO (the default) only conditional 
+# compilation will be performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled 
+# way by setting EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES.
+
+MACRO_EXPANSION        = YES
+
+# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES 
+# then the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the 
+# PREDEFINED and EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags.
+
+EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF     = YES
+
+# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES (the default) the includes files 
+# in the INCLUDE_PATH (see below) will be search if a #include is found.
+
+SEARCH_INCLUDES        = YES
+
+# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that 
+# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by 
+# the preprocessor.
+
+INCLUDE_PATH           = 
+
+# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard 
+# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the 
+# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will 
+# be used.
+
+INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS  = 
+
+# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that 
+# are defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of 
+# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name 
+# or name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the = are 
+# omitted =1 is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being 
+# undefined via #undef or recursively expanded use the := operator 
+# instead of the = operator.
+
+PREDEFINED             = __DOXYGEN__
+
+# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then 
+# this tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. 
+# The macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. 
+# Use the PREDEFINED tag if you want to use a different macro definition.
+
+EXPAND_AS_DEFINED      = BUTTLOADTAG
+
+# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES (the default) then 
+# doxygen's preprocessor will remove all function-like macros that are alone 
+# on a line, have an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such 
+# function macros are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse 
+# the parser if not removed.
+
+SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS   = YES
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# Configuration::additions related to external references   
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# The TAGFILES option can be used to specify one or more tagfiles. 
+# Optionally an initial location of the external documentation 
+# can be added for each tagfile. The format of a tag file without 
+# this location is as follows: 
+#   TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... 
+# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: 
+#   TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... 
+# where "loc1" and "loc2" can be relative or absolute paths or 
+# URLs. If a location is present for each tag, the installdox tool 
+# does not have to be run to correct the links.
+# Note that each tag file must have a unique name
+# (where the name does NOT include the path)
+# If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen 
+# is run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here.
+
+TAGFILES               = 
+
+# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create 
+# a tag file that is based on the input files it reads.
+
+GENERATE_TAGFILE       = 
+
+# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES all external classes will be listed 
+# in the class index. If set to NO only the inherited external classes 
+# will be listed.
+
+ALLEXTERNALS           = NO
+
+# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES all external groups will be listed 
+# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will 
+# be listed.
+
+EXTERNAL_GROUPS        = YES
+
+# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script 
+# interpreter (i.e. the result of `which perl').
+
+PERL_PATH              = /usr/bin/perl
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# Configuration options related to the dot tool   
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will 
+# generate a inheritance diagram (in HTML, RTF and LaTeX) for classes with base 
+# or super classes. Setting the tag to NO turns the diagrams off. Note that 
+# this option is superseded by the HAVE_DOT option below. This is only a 
+# fallback. It is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more 
+# powerful graphs.
+
+CLASS_DIAGRAMS         = NO
+
+# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc 
+# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see 
+# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/) to produce the chart and insert it in the 
+# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where 
+# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the 
+# default search path.
+
+MSCGEN_PATH            = 
+
+# If set to YES, the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide 
+# inheritance and usage relations if the target is undocumented 
+# or is not a class.
+
+HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS   = YES
+
+# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is 
+# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz, a graph visualization 
+# toolkit from AT&T and Lucent Bell Labs. The other options in this section 
+# have no effect if this option is set to NO (the default)
+
+HAVE_DOT               = NO
+
+# By default doxygen will write a font called FreeSans.ttf to the output 
+# directory and reference it in all dot files that doxygen generates. This 
+# font does not include all possible unicode characters however, so when you need 
+# these (or just want a differently looking font) you can specify the font name 
+# using DOT_FONTNAME. You need need to make sure dot is able to find the font, 
+# which can be done by putting it in a standard location or by setting the 
+# DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory 
+# containing the font.
+
+DOT_FONTNAME           = FreeSans
+
+# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size of the font of dot graphs. 
+# The default size is 10pt.
+
+DOT_FONTSIZE           = 10
+
+# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the output directory to look for the 
+# FreeSans.ttf font (which doxygen will put there itself). If you specify a 
+# different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set the path where dot 
+# can find it using this tag.
+
+DOT_FONTPATH           = 
+
+# If the CLASS_GRAPH and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen 
+# will generate a graph for each documented class showing the direct and 
+# indirect inheritance relations. Setting this tag to YES will force the 
+# the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO.
+
+CLASS_GRAPH            = NO
+
+# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen 
+# will generate a graph for each documented class showing the direct and 
+# indirect implementation dependencies (inheritance, containment, and 
+# class references variables) of the class with other documented classes.
+
+COLLABORATION_GRAPH    = NO
+
+# If the GROUP_GRAPHS and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen 
+# will generate a graph for groups, showing the direct groups dependencies
+
+GROUP_GRAPHS           = NO
+
+# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES doxygen will generate inheritance and 
+# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling 
+# Language.
+
+UML_LOOK               = NO
+
+# If set to YES, the inheritance and collaboration graphs will show the 
+# relations between templates and their instances.
+
+TEMPLATE_RELATIONS     = NO
+
+# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING, SEARCH_INCLUDES, INCLUDE_GRAPH, and HAVE_DOT 
+# tags are set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented 
+# file showing the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with 
+# other documented files.
+
+INCLUDE_GRAPH          = NO
+
+# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING, SEARCH_INCLUDES, INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, and 
+# HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each 
+# documented header file showing the documented files that directly or 
+# indirectly include this file.
+
+INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH      = NO
+
+# If the CALL_GRAPH and HAVE_DOT options are set to YES then 
+# doxygen will generate a call dependency graph for every global function 
+# or class method. Note that enabling this option will significantly increase 
+# the time of a run. So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs 
+# for selected functions only using the \callgraph command.
+
+CALL_GRAPH             = NO
+
+# If the CALLER_GRAPH and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then 
+# doxygen will generate a caller dependency graph for every global function 
+# or class method. Note that enabling this option will significantly increase 
+# the time of a run. So in most cases it will be better to enable caller 
+# graphs for selected functions only using the \callergraph command.
+
+CALLER_GRAPH           = NO
+
+# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen 
+# will graphical hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one.
+
+GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY    = NO
+
+# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH, SHOW_DIRECTORIES and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES 
+# then doxygen will show the dependencies a directory has on other directories 
+# in a graphical way. The dependency relations are determined by the #include
+# relations between the files in the directories.
+
+DIRECTORY_GRAPH        = NO
+
+# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images 
+# generated by dot. Possible values are png, jpg, or gif
+# If left blank png will be used.
+
+DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT       = png
+
+# The tag DOT_PATH can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be 
+# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path.
+
+DOT_PATH               = "C:/Program Files/Graphviz2.18/bin"
+
+# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that 
+# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the 
+# \dotfile command).
+
+DOTFILE_DIRS           = 
+
+# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of 
+# nodes that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph 
+# becomes larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is 
+# visualized by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the 
+# number of direct children of the root node in a graph is already larger than 
+# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note 
+# that the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH.
+
+DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES    = 15
+
+# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the 
+# graphs generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable 
+# from the root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes 
+# that lay further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this 
+# option to 1 or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large 
+# code bases. Also note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by 
+# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction.
+
+MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH    = 2
+
+# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent 
+# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not 
+# seem to support this out of the box. Warning: Depending on the platform used, 
+# enabling this option may lead to badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of 
+# a graph (i.e. they become hard to read).
+
+DOT_TRANSPARENT        = YES
+
+# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES allow dot to generate multiple output 
+# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This 
+# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) 
+# support this, this feature is disabled by default.
+
+DOT_MULTI_TARGETS      = NO
+
+# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will 
+# generate a legend page explaining the meaning of the various boxes and 
+# arrows in the dot generated graphs.
+
+GENERATE_LEGEND        = YES
+
+# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will 
+# remove the intermediate dot files that are used to generate 
+# the various graphs.
+
+DOT_CLEANUP            = YES
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# Configuration::additions related to the search engine   
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# The SEARCHENGINE tag specifies whether or not a search engine should be 
+# used. If set to NO the values of all tags below this one will be ignored.
+
+SEARCHENGINE           = NO
diff --git a/Bootloaders/DFU/makefile b/Bootloaders/DFU/makefile
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..5a8e4eeed
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Bootloaders/DFU/makefile
@@ -0,0 +1,714 @@
+# Hey Emacs, this is a -*- makefile -*-
+#----------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# WinAVR Makefile Template written by Eric B. Weddington, J�rg Wunsch, et al.
+#  >> Modified for use with the LUFA project. <<
+#
+# Released to the Public Domain
+#
+# Additional material for this makefile was written by:
+# Peter Fleury
+# Tim Henigan
+# Colin O'Flynn
+# Reiner Patommel
+# Markus Pfaff
+# Sander Pool
+# Frederik Rouleau
+# Carlos Lamas
+# Dean Camera
+# Opendous Inc.
+# Denver Gingerich
+#
+#----------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# On command line:
+#
+# make all = Make software.
+#
+# make clean = Clean out built project files.
+#
+# make coff = Convert ELF to AVR COFF.
+#
+# make extcoff = Convert ELF to AVR Extended COFF.
+#
+# make program = Download the hex file to the device, using avrdude.
+#                Please customize the avrdude settings below first!
+#
+# make dfu = Download the hex file to the device, using dfu-programmer (must
+#            have dfu-programmer installed).
+#
+# make flip = Download the hex file to the device, using Atmel FLIP (must
+#             have Atmel FLIP installed).
+#
+# make dfu-ee = Download the eeprom file to the device, using dfu-programmer
+#               (must have dfu-programmer installed).
+#
+# make flip-ee = Download the eeprom file to the device, using Atmel FLIP
+#                (must have Atmel FLIP installed).
+#
+# make doxygen = Generate DoxyGen documentation for the project (must have
+#                DoxyGen installed)
+#
+# make debug = Start either simulavr or avarice as specified for debugging, 
+#              with avr-gdb or avr-insight as the front end for debugging.
+#
+# make filename.s = Just compile filename.c into the assembler code only.
+#
+# make filename.i = Create a preprocessed source file for use in submitting
+#                   bug reports to the GCC project.
+#
+# To rebuild project do "make clean" then "make all".
+#----------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+
+# MCU name
+MCU = at90usb1287
+
+
+# Target board (see library BoardTypes.h documentation, USER or blank for projects not requiring
+# LUFA board drivers). If USER is selected, put custom board drivers in a directory called 
+# "Board" inside the application directory.
+BOARD  = USBKEY
+
+
+# Processor frequency.
+#     This will define a symbol, F_CPU, in all source code files equal to the 
+#     processor frequency. You can then use this symbol in your source code to 
+#     calculate timings. Do NOT tack on a 'UL' at the end, this will be done
+#     automatically to create a 32-bit value in your source code.
+#     Typical values are:
+#         F_CPU =  1000000
+#         F_CPU =  1843200
+#         F_CPU =  2000000
+#         F_CPU =  3686400
+#         F_CPU =  4000000
+#         F_CPU =  7372800
+#         F_CPU =  8000000
+#         F_CPU = 11059200
+#         F_CPU = 14745600
+#         F_CPU = 16000000
+#         F_CPU = 18432000
+#         F_CPU = 20000000
+F_CPU = 8000000
+
+
+# Output format. (can be srec, ihex, binary)
+FORMAT = ihex
+
+
+# Target file name (without extension).
+TARGET = BootloaderDFU
+
+
+# Object files directory
+#     To put object files in current directory, use a dot (.), do NOT make
+#     this an empty or blank macro!
+OBJDIR = .
+
+
+# List C source files here. (C dependencies are automatically generated.)
+SRC = $(TARGET).c                                          \
+	  Descriptors.c                                        \
+	  ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/LowLevel.c           \
+	  ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/Endpoint.c           \
+	  ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/DevChapter9.c        \
+	  ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/USBTask.c           \
+	  ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/USBInterrupt.c      \
+	  ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/Events.c            \
+	  ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/StdDescriptors.c    \
+	  
+# List C++ source files here. (C dependencies are automatically generated.)
+CPPSRC = 
+
+
+# List Assembler source files here.
+#     Make them always end in a capital .S.  Files ending in a lowercase .s
+#     will not be considered source files but generated files (assembler
+#     output from the compiler), and will be deleted upon "make clean"!
+#     Even though the DOS/Win* filesystem matches both .s and .S the same,
+#     it will preserve the spelling of the filenames, and gcc itself does
+#     care about how the name is spelled on its command-line.
+ASRC = 
+
+
+# Optimization level, can be [0, 1, 2, 3, s]. 
+#     0 = turn off optimization. s = optimize for size.
+#     (Note: 3 is not always the best optimization level. See avr-libc FAQ.)
+OPT = s
+
+
+# Debugging format.
+#     Native formats for AVR-GCC's -g are dwarf-2 [default] or stabs.
+#     AVR Studio 4.10 requires dwarf-2.
+#     AVR [Extended] COFF format requires stabs, plus an avr-objcopy run.
+DEBUG = dwarf-2
+
+
+# List any extra directories to look for include files here.
+#     Each directory must be seperated by a space.
+#     Use forward slashes for directory separators.
+#     For a directory that has spaces, enclose it in quotes.
+EXTRAINCDIRS = ../../
+
+
+# Compiler flag to set the C Standard level.
+#     c89   = "ANSI" C
+#     gnu89 = c89 plus GCC extensions
+#     c99   = ISO C99 standard (not yet fully implemented)
+#     gnu99 = c99 plus GCC extensions
+CSTANDARD = -std=gnu99
+
+
+# Starting byte address of the bootloader
+BOOT_START = 0x1E000
+
+
+# Place -D or -U options here for C sources
+CDEFS  = -DF_CPU=$(F_CPU)UL -DBOARD=BOARD_$(BOARD) -DUSE_NONSTANDARD_DESCRIPTOR_NAMES -DSTATIC_ENDPOINT_CONFIGURATION
+CDEFS += -DUSB_DEVICE_ONLY -DUSE_STATIC_OPTIONS="(USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL)"
+CDEFS += -DUSE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS -DBOOT_START_ADDR=$(BOOT_START)UL -DFIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE=32 -DUSE_SINGLE_DEVICE_CONFIGURATION
+CDEFS += -DNO_CLEARSET_FEATURE_REQUEST
+
+# Place -D or -U options here for ASM sources
+ADEFS = -DF_CPU=$(F_CPU)
+
+
+# Place -D or -U options here for C++ sources
+CPPDEFS = -DF_CPU=$(F_CPU)UL
+#CPPDEFS += -D__STDC_LIMIT_MACROS
+#CPPDEFS += -D__STDC_CONSTANT_MACROS
+
+
+
+#---------------- Compiler Options C ----------------
+#  -g*:          generate debugging information
+#  -O*:          optimization level
+#  -f...:        tuning, see GCC manual and avr-libc documentation
+#  -Wall...:     warning level
+#  -Wa,...:      tell GCC to pass this to the assembler.
+#    -adhlns...: create assembler listing
+CFLAGS = -g$(DEBUG)
+CFLAGS += $(CDEFS)
+CFLAGS += -O$(OPT)
+CFLAGS += -funsigned-char
+CFLAGS += -funsigned-bitfields
+CFLAGS += -ffunction-sections
+CFLAGS += -fdata-sections
+CFLAGS += -fpack-struct
+CFLAGS += -fshort-enums
+CFLAGS += -fno-inline-small-functions
+CFLAGS += -fno-reorder-blocks
+CFLAGS += -fno-reorder-blocks-and-partition
+CFLAGS += -fno-reorder-functions
+CFLAGS += -fno-toplevel-reorder
+CFLAGS += -Wall
+CFLAGS += -Wstrict-prototypes
+CFLAGS += -Wundef
+#CFLAGS += -fno-unit-at-a-time
+#CFLAGS += -Wunreachable-code
+#CFLAGS += -Wsign-compare
+CFLAGS += -Wa,-adhlns=$(<:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst)
+CFLAGS += $(patsubst %,-I%,$(EXTRAINCDIRS))
+CFLAGS += $(CSTANDARD)
+
+
+#---------------- Compiler Options C++ ----------------
+#  -g*:          generate debugging information
+#  -O*:          optimization level
+#  -f...:        tuning, see GCC manual and avr-libc documentation
+#  -Wall...:     warning level
+#  -Wa,...:      tell GCC to pass this to the assembler.
+#    -adhlns...: create assembler listing
+CPPFLAGS = -g$(DEBUG)
+CPPFLAGS += $(CPPDEFS)
+CPPFLAGS += -O$(OPT)
+CPPFLAGS += -funsigned-char
+CPPFLAGS += -funsigned-bitfields
+CPPFLAGS += -fpack-struct
+CPPFLAGS += -fshort-enums
+CPPFLAGS += -fno-exceptions
+CPPFLAGS += -Wall
+CFLAGS += -Wundef
+#CPPFLAGS += -mshort-calls
+#CPPFLAGS += -fno-unit-at-a-time
+#CPPFLAGS += -Wstrict-prototypes
+#CPPFLAGS += -Wunreachable-code
+#CPPFLAGS += -Wsign-compare
+CPPFLAGS += -Wa,-adhlns=$(<:%.cpp=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst)
+CPPFLAGS += $(patsubst %,-I%,$(EXTRAINCDIRS))
+#CPPFLAGS += $(CSTANDARD)
+
+
+#---------------- Assembler Options ----------------
+#  -Wa,...:   tell GCC to pass this to the assembler.
+#  -adhlns:   create listing
+#  -gstabs:   have the assembler create line number information; note that
+#             for use in COFF files, additional information about filenames
+#             and function names needs to be present in the assembler source
+#             files -- see avr-libc docs [FIXME: not yet described there]
+#  -listing-cont-lines: Sets the maximum number of continuation lines of hex 
+#       dump that will be displayed for a given single line of source input.
+ASFLAGS = $(ADEFS) -Wa,-adhlns=$(<:%.S=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst),-gstabs,--listing-cont-lines=100
+
+
+#---------------- Library Options ----------------
+# Minimalistic printf version
+PRINTF_LIB_MIN = -Wl,-u,vfprintf -lprintf_min
+
+# Floating point printf version (requires MATH_LIB = -lm below)
+PRINTF_LIB_FLOAT = -Wl,-u,vfprintf -lprintf_flt
+
+# If this is left blank, then it will use the Standard printf version.
+PRINTF_LIB = 
+#PRINTF_LIB = $(PRINTF_LIB_MIN)
+#PRINTF_LIB = $(PRINTF_LIB_FLOAT)
+
+
+# Minimalistic scanf version
+SCANF_LIB_MIN = -Wl,-u,vfscanf -lscanf_min
+
+# Floating point + %[ scanf version (requires MATH_LIB = -lm below)
+SCANF_LIB_FLOAT = -Wl,-u,vfscanf -lscanf_flt
+
+# If this is left blank, then it will use the Standard scanf version.
+SCANF_LIB = 
+#SCANF_LIB = $(SCANF_LIB_MIN)
+#SCANF_LIB = $(SCANF_LIB_FLOAT)
+
+
+MATH_LIB = -lm
+
+
+# List any extra directories to look for libraries here.
+#     Each directory must be seperated by a space.
+#     Use forward slashes for directory separators.
+#     For a directory that has spaces, enclose it in quotes.
+EXTRALIBDIRS = 
+
+
+
+#---------------- External Memory Options ----------------
+
+# 64 KB of external RAM, starting after internal RAM (ATmega128!),
+# used for variables (.data/.bss) and heap (malloc()).
+#EXTMEMOPTS = -Wl,-Tdata=0x801100,--defsym=__heap_end=0x80ffff
+
+# 64 KB of external RAM, starting after internal RAM (ATmega128!),
+# only used for heap (malloc()).
+#EXTMEMOPTS = -Wl,--section-start,.data=0x801100,--defsym=__heap_end=0x80ffff
+
+EXTMEMOPTS =
+
+
+
+#---------------- Linker Options ----------------
+#  -Wl,...:     tell GCC to pass this to linker.
+#    -Map:      create map file
+#    --cref:    add cross reference to  map file
+LDFLAGS = -Wl,-Map=$(TARGET).map,--cref
+LDFLAGS += -Wl,--relax
+LDFLAGS += -Wl,--gc-sections
+LDFLAGS += -Wl,--section-start=.text=$(BOOT_START)
+LDFLAGS += $(EXTMEMOPTS)
+LDFLAGS += $(patsubst %,-L%,$(EXTRALIBDIRS))
+LDFLAGS += $(PRINTF_LIB) $(SCANF_LIB) $(MATH_LIB)
+#LDFLAGS += -T linker_script.x
+
+
+
+#---------------- Programming Options (avrdude) ----------------
+
+# Programming hardware: alf avr910 avrisp bascom bsd 
+# dt006 pavr picoweb pony-stk200 sp12 stk200 stk500
+#
+# Type: avrdude -c ?
+# to get a full listing.
+#
+AVRDUDE_PROGRAMMER = jtagmkII
+
+# com1 = serial port. Use lpt1 to connect to parallel port.
+AVRDUDE_PORT = usb
+
+AVRDUDE_WRITE_FLASH = -U flash:w:$(TARGET).hex
+#AVRDUDE_WRITE_EEPROM = -U eeprom:w:$(TARGET).eep
+
+
+# Uncomment the following if you want avrdude's erase cycle counter.
+# Note that this counter needs to be initialized first using -Yn,
+# see avrdude manual.
+#AVRDUDE_ERASE_COUNTER = -y
+
+# Uncomment the following if you do /not/ wish a verification to be
+# performed after programming the device.
+AVRDUDE_NO_VERIFY = -V
+
+# Increase verbosity level.  Please use this when submitting bug
+# reports about avrdude. See <http://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/avrdude> 
+# to submit bug reports.
+#AVRDUDE_VERBOSE = -v -v
+
+AVRDUDE_FLAGS = -p $(MCU) -P $(AVRDUDE_PORT) -c $(AVRDUDE_PROGRAMMER)
+AVRDUDE_FLAGS += $(AVRDUDE_NO_VERIFY)
+AVRDUDE_FLAGS += $(AVRDUDE_VERBOSE)
+AVRDUDE_FLAGS += $(AVRDUDE_ERASE_COUNTER)
+
+
+
+#---------------- Debugging Options ----------------
+
+# For simulavr only - target MCU frequency.
+DEBUG_MFREQ = $(F_CPU)
+
+# Set the DEBUG_UI to either gdb or insight.
+# DEBUG_UI = gdb
+DEBUG_UI = insight
+
+# Set the debugging back-end to either avarice, simulavr.
+DEBUG_BACKEND = avarice
+#DEBUG_BACKEND = simulavr
+
+# GDB Init Filename.
+GDBINIT_FILE = __avr_gdbinit
+
+# When using avarice settings for the JTAG
+JTAG_DEV = /dev/com1
+
+# Debugging port used to communicate between GDB / avarice / simulavr.
+DEBUG_PORT = 4242
+
+# Debugging host used to communicate between GDB / avarice / simulavr, normally
+#     just set to localhost unless doing some sort of crazy debugging when 
+#     avarice is running on a different computer.
+DEBUG_HOST = localhost
+
+
+
+#============================================================================
+
+
+# Define programs and commands.
+SHELL = sh
+CC = avr-gcc
+OBJCOPY = avr-objcopy
+OBJDUMP = avr-objdump
+SIZE = avr-size
+AR = avr-ar rcs
+NM = avr-nm
+AVRDUDE = avrdude
+REMOVE = rm -f
+REMOVEDIR = rm -rf
+COPY = cp
+WINSHELL = cmd
+
+# Define Messages
+# English
+MSG_ERRORS_NONE = Errors: none
+MSG_BEGIN = -------- begin --------
+MSG_END = --------  end  --------
+MSG_SIZE_BEFORE = Size before: 
+MSG_SIZE_AFTER = Size after:
+MSG_COFF = Converting to AVR COFF:
+MSG_EXTENDED_COFF = Converting to AVR Extended COFF:
+MSG_FLASH = Creating load file for Flash:
+MSG_EEPROM = Creating load file for EEPROM:
+MSG_EXTENDED_LISTING = Creating Extended Listing:
+MSG_SYMBOL_TABLE = Creating Symbol Table:
+MSG_LINKING = Linking:
+MSG_COMPILING = Compiling C:
+MSG_COMPILING_CPP = Compiling C++:
+MSG_ASSEMBLING = Assembling:
+MSG_CLEANING = Cleaning project:
+MSG_CREATING_LIBRARY = Creating library:
+
+
+
+
+# Define all object files.
+OBJ = $(SRC:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.o) $(CPPSRC:%.cpp=$(OBJDIR)/%.o) $(ASRC:%.S=$(OBJDIR)/%.o) 
+
+# Define all listing files.
+LST = $(SRC:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst) $(CPPSRC:%.cpp=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst) $(ASRC:%.S=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst) 
+
+
+# Compiler flags to generate dependency files.
+GENDEPFLAGS = -MMD -MP -MF .dep/$(@F).d
+
+
+# Combine all necessary flags and optional flags.
+# Add target processor to flags.
+ALL_CFLAGS = -mmcu=$(MCU) -I. $(CFLAGS) $(GENDEPFLAGS)
+ALL_CPPFLAGS = -mmcu=$(MCU) -I. -x c++ $(CPPFLAGS) $(GENDEPFLAGS)
+ALL_ASFLAGS = -mmcu=$(MCU) -I. -x assembler-with-cpp $(ASFLAGS)
+
+
+
+
+
+# Default target.
+all: begin gccversion sizebefore build checkhooks checklibmode sizeafter end
+
+# Change the build target to build a HEX file or a library.
+build: elf hex eep lss sym
+#build: lib
+
+
+elf: $(TARGET).elf
+hex: $(TARGET).hex
+eep: $(TARGET).eep
+lss: $(TARGET).lss
+sym: $(TARGET).sym
+LIBNAME=lib$(TARGET).a
+lib: $(LIBNAME)
+
+
+
+# Eye candy.
+# AVR Studio 3.x does not check make's exit code but relies on
+# the following magic strings to be generated by the compile job.
+begin:
+	@echo
+	@echo $(MSG_BEGIN)
+
+end:
+	@echo $(MSG_END)
+	@echo
+
+
+# Display size of file.
+HEXSIZE = $(SIZE) --target=$(FORMAT) $(TARGET).hex
+ELFSIZE = $(SIZE) $(MCU_FLAG) $(FORMAT_FLAG) $(TARGET).elf
+MCU_FLAG = $(shell $(SIZE) --help | grep -- --mcu > /dev/null && echo --mcu=$(MCU) )
+FORMAT_FLAG = $(shell $(SIZE) --help | grep -- --format=.*avr > /dev/null && echo --format=avr )
+
+sizebefore:
+	@if test -f $(TARGET).elf; then echo; echo $(MSG_SIZE_BEFORE); $(ELFSIZE); \
+	2>/dev/null; echo; fi
+
+sizeafter:
+	@if test -f $(TARGET).elf; then echo; echo $(MSG_SIZE_AFTER); $(ELFSIZE); \
+	2>/dev/null; echo; fi
+
+checkhooks: build
+	@echo
+	@echo ------- Unhooked LUFA Events -------
+	@$(shell) (grep -s '^Event.*LUFA/.*\\.o' $(TARGET).map | \
+	           cut -d' ' -f1 | cut -d'_' -f2- | grep ".*") || \
+			   echo "(None)"
+	@echo ----- End Unhooked LUFA Events -----
+	
+checklibmode:
+	@echo
+	@echo ----------- Library Mode -----------
+	@$(shell) ($(CC) $(ALL_CFLAGS) -E -dM - < /dev/null \
+	          | grep 'USB_\(DEVICE\|HOST\)_ONLY' | cut -d' ' -f2 | grep ".*") \
+	          || echo "No specific mode (both device and host mode allowable)."
+	@echo ------------------------------------
+
+# Display compiler version information.
+gccversion : 
+	@$(CC) --version
+
+
+
+# Program the device.  
+program: $(TARGET).hex $(TARGET).eep
+	$(AVRDUDE) $(AVRDUDE_FLAGS) $(AVRDUDE_WRITE_FLASH) $(AVRDUDE_WRITE_EEPROM)
+
+flip: $(TARGET).hex
+	batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation erase f
+	batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation loadbuffer $(TARGET).hex program
+	batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation start reset 0
+
+dfu: $(TARGET).hex
+	dfu-programmer $(MCU) erase
+	dfu-programmer $(MCU) flash --debug 1 $(TARGET).hex
+	dfu-programmer $(MCU) reset
+
+flip-ee: $(TARGET).hex $(TARGET).eep
+	copy $(TARGET).eep $(TARGET)eep.hex
+	batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation memory EEPROM erase
+	batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation memory EEPROM loadbuffer $(TARGET)eep.hex program
+	batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation start reset 0
+
+dfu-ee: $(TARGET).hex $(TARGET).eep
+	dfu-programmer $(MCU) erase
+	dfu-programmer $(MCU) eeprom --debug 1 $(TARGET).eep
+	dfu-programmer $(MCU) reset
+
+# Generate avr-gdb config/init file which does the following:
+#     define the reset signal, load the target file, connect to target, and set 
+#     a breakpoint at main().
+gdb-config: 
+	@$(REMOVE) $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+	@echo define reset >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+	@echo SIGNAL SIGHUP >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+	@echo end >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+	@echo file $(TARGET).elf >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+	@echo target remote $(DEBUG_HOST):$(DEBUG_PORT)  >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+ifeq ($(DEBUG_BACKEND),simulavr)
+	@echo load  >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+endif
+	@echo break main >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+
+debug: gdb-config $(TARGET).elf
+ifeq ($(DEBUG_BACKEND), avarice)
+	@echo Starting AVaRICE - Press enter when "waiting to connect" message displays.
+	@$(WINSHELL) /c start avarice --jtag $(JTAG_DEV) --erase --program --file \
+	$(TARGET).elf $(DEBUG_HOST):$(DEBUG_PORT)
+	@$(WINSHELL) /c pause
+
+else
+	@$(WINSHELL) /c start simulavr --gdbserver --device $(MCU) --clock-freq \
+	$(DEBUG_MFREQ) --port $(DEBUG_PORT)
+endif
+	@$(WINSHELL) /c start avr-$(DEBUG_UI) --command=$(GDBINIT_FILE)
+
+
+
+
+# Convert ELF to COFF for use in debugging / simulating in AVR Studio or VMLAB.
+COFFCONVERT = $(OBJCOPY) --debugging
+COFFCONVERT += --change-section-address .data-0x800000
+COFFCONVERT += --change-section-address .bss-0x800000
+COFFCONVERT += --change-section-address .noinit-0x800000
+COFFCONVERT += --change-section-address .eeprom-0x810000
+
+
+
+coff: $(TARGET).elf
+	@echo
+	@echo $(MSG_COFF) $(TARGET).cof
+	$(COFFCONVERT) -O coff-avr $< $(TARGET).cof
+
+
+extcoff: $(TARGET).elf
+	@echo
+	@echo $(MSG_EXTENDED_COFF) $(TARGET).cof
+	$(COFFCONVERT) -O coff-ext-avr $< $(TARGET).cof
+
+
+
+# Create final output files (.hex, .eep) from ELF output file.
+%.hex: %.elf
+	@echo
+	@echo $(MSG_FLASH) $@
+	$(OBJCOPY) -O $(FORMAT) -R .eeprom $< $@
+
+%.eep: %.elf
+	@echo
+	@echo $(MSG_EEPROM) $@
+	-$(OBJCOPY) -j .eeprom --set-section-flags=.eeprom="alloc,load" \
+	--change-section-lma .eeprom=0 --no-change-warnings -O $(FORMAT) $< $@ || exit 0
+
+# Create extended listing file from ELF output file.
+%.lss: %.elf
+	@echo
+	@echo $(MSG_EXTENDED_LISTING) $@
+	$(OBJDUMP) -h -z -S $< > $@
+
+# Create a symbol table from ELF output file.
+%.sym: %.elf
+	@echo
+	@echo $(MSG_SYMBOL_TABLE) $@
+	$(NM) -n $< > $@
+
+
+
+# Create library from object files.
+.SECONDARY : $(TARGET).a
+.PRECIOUS : $(OBJ)
+%.a: $(OBJ)
+	@echo
+	@echo $(MSG_CREATING_LIBRARY) $@
+	$(AR) $@ $(OBJ)
+
+
+# Link: create ELF output file from object files.
+.SECONDARY : $(TARGET).elf
+.PRECIOUS : $(OBJ)
+%.elf: $(OBJ)
+	@echo
+	@echo $(MSG_LINKING) $@
+	$(CC) $(ALL_CFLAGS) $^ --output $@ $(LDFLAGS)
+
+
+# Compile: create object files from C source files.
+$(OBJDIR)/%.o : %.c
+	@echo
+	@echo $(MSG_COMPILING) $<
+	$(CC) -c $(ALL_CFLAGS) $< -o $@ 
+
+
+# Compile: create object files from C++ source files.
+$(OBJDIR)/%.o : %.cpp
+	@echo
+	@echo $(MSG_COMPILING_CPP) $<
+	$(CC) -c $(ALL_CPPFLAGS) $< -o $@ 
+
+
+# Compile: create assembler files from C source files.
+%.s : %.c
+	$(CC) -S $(ALL_CFLAGS) $< -o $@
+
+
+# Compile: create assembler files from C++ source files.
+%.s : %.cpp
+	$(CC) -S $(ALL_CPPFLAGS) $< -o $@
+
+
+# Assemble: create object files from assembler source files.
+$(OBJDIR)/%.o : %.S
+	@echo
+	@echo $(MSG_ASSEMBLING) $<
+	$(CC) -c $(ALL_ASFLAGS) $< -o $@
+
+
+# Create preprocessed source for use in sending a bug report.
+%.i : %.c
+	$(CC) -E -mmcu=$(MCU) -I. $(CFLAGS) $< -o $@ 
+	
+
+# Target: clean project.
+clean: begin clean_list clean_binary end
+
+clean_binary:
+	$(REMOVE) $(TARGET).hex
+
+clean_list:
+	@echo $(MSG_CLEANING)
+	$(REMOVE) $(TARGET).eep
+	$(REMOVE) $(TARGET).cof
+	$(REMOVE) $(TARGET).elf
+	$(REMOVE) $(TARGET).map
+	$(REMOVE) $(TARGET).sym
+	$(REMOVE) $(TARGET).lss
+	$(REMOVE) $(SRC:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.o)
+	$(REMOVE) $(SRC:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst)
+	$(REMOVE) $(ASRC:%.S=$(OBJDIR)/%.o)
+	$(REMOVE) $(ASRC:%.S=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst)
+	$(REMOVE) $(SRC:.c=.s)
+	$(REMOVE) $(SRC:.c=.d)
+	$(REMOVE) $(SRC:.c=.i)
+	$(REMOVEDIR) .dep
+
+
+doxygen:
+	@echo Generating Project Documentation...
+	@doxygen Doxygen.conf
+	@echo Documentation Generation Complete.
+	
+clean_doxygen:
+	rm -rf Documentation
+
+# Create object files directory
+$(shell mkdir $(OBJDIR) 2>/dev/null)
+
+
+# Include the dependency files.
+-include $(shell mkdir .dep 2>/dev/null) $(wildcard .dep/*)
+
+
+# Listing of phony targets.
+.PHONY : all checkhooks checklibmode begin  \
+finish end sizebefore sizeafter gccversion  \
+build elf hex eep lss sym coff extcoff      \
+clean clean_list clean_binary program debug \
+gdb-config doxygen clean_doxygen
diff --git a/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/Descriptors.c b/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/Descriptors.c
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..adfbe6c25
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/Descriptors.c
@@ -0,0 +1,218 @@
+/*
+             LUFA Library
+     Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2009.
+              
+  dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+      www.fourwalledcubicle.com
+*/
+
+/*
+  Copyright 2009  Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com)
+	  
+  Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software
+  and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby
+  granted, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all
+  copies and that both that the copyright notice and this
+  permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting
+  documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in
+  advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
+  software without specific, written prior permission.
+
+  The author disclaim all warranties with regard to this
+  software, including all implied warranties of merchantability
+  and fitness.  In no event shall the author be liable for any
+  special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages
+  whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether
+  in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action,
+  arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of
+  this software.
+*/
+
+/** \file
+ *
+ *  USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special 
+ *  computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine
+ *  the device's capabilities and functions.  
+ */
+
+#include "Descriptors.h"
+
+/** HID class report descriptor. This is a special descriptor constructed with values from the
+ *  USBIF HID class specification to describe the reports and capabilities of the HID device. This
+ *  descriptor is parsed by the host and its contents used to determine what data (and in what encoding)
+ *  the device will send, and what it may be sent back from the host. Refer to the HID specification for
+ *  more details on HID report descriptors.
+ */
+USB_Descriptor_HIDReport_Datatype_t HIDReport[] =
+{
+	0x06, 0x9c, 0xff,     /* Usage Page (Vendor Defined)                     */
+	0x09, 0x19,           /* Usage (Vendor Defined)                          */
+	0xa1, 0x01,           /* Collection (Vendor Defined)                     */
+	0x0a, 0x19, 0x00,     /*   Usage (Vendor Defined)                        */
+	0x75, 0x08,           /*   Report Size (8)                               */
+	0x95, 0x82,           /*   Report Count (130)                            */
+	0x15, 0x00,           /*   Logical Minimum (0)                           */
+	0x25, 0xff,           /*   Logical Maximum (255)                         */
+	0x91, 0x02,           /*   Output (Data, Variable, Absolute)             */
+	0xc0                  /* End Collection                                  */
+};
+
+/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall
+ *  device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the
+ *  number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration
+ *  process begins.
+ */
+USB_Descriptor_Device_t DeviceDescriptor =
+{
+	Header:                 {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), Type: DTYPE_Device},
+		
+	USBSpecification:       VERSION_BCD(01.10),
+	Class:                  0x00,
+	SubClass:               0x00,
+	Protocol:               0x00,
+				
+	Endpoint0Size:          8,
+		
+	VendorID:               0x16C0,
+	ProductID:              0x0478,
+	ReleaseNumber:          0x0010,
+		
+	ManufacturerStrIndex:   NO_DESCRIPTOR,
+	ProductStrIndex:        0x01,
+	SerialNumStrIndex:      NO_DESCRIPTOR,
+		
+	NumberOfConfigurations: 1
+};
+
+/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage
+ *  of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces
+ *  and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting
+ *  a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device.
+ */
+USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t ConfigurationDescriptor =
+{
+	Config:
+		{
+			Header:                 {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), Type: DTYPE_Configuration},
+
+			TotalConfigurationSize: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t),
+			TotalInterfaces:        1,
+				
+			ConfigurationNumber:    1,
+			ConfigurationStrIndex:  NO_DESCRIPTOR,
+				
+			ConfigAttributes:       (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_BUSPOWERED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED),
+			
+			MaxPowerConsumption:    USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100)
+		},
+		
+	Interface:
+		{
+			Header:                 {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), Type: DTYPE_Interface},
+
+			InterfaceNumber:        0x00,
+			AlternateSetting:       0x00,
+			
+			TotalEndpoints:         1,
+				
+			Class:                  0x03,
+			SubClass:               0x00,
+			Protocol:               0x00,
+				
+			InterfaceStrIndex:      NO_DESCRIPTOR
+		},
+
+	HIDDescriptor:
+		{  
+			Header:                 {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_HID_t), Type: DTYPE_HID},
+			
+			HIDSpec:                VERSION_BCD(01.11),
+			CountryCode:            0x00,
+			TotalHIDReports:        0x01,
+			HIDReportType:          DTYPE_Report,
+			HIDReportLength:        sizeof(HIDReport)
+		},
+		
+	HIDEndpoint:
+		{
+			Header:                 {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), Type: DTYPE_Endpoint},
+
+			EndpointAddress:        (ENDPOINT_DESCRIPTOR_DIR_IN | HID_EPNUM),
+			Attributes:             EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT,
+			EndpointSize:           HID_EPSIZE,
+			PollingIntervalMS:      0x40
+		},
+};
+
+/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests
+ *  the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate
+ *  via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors.
+ */
+USB_Descriptor_String_t LanguageString =
+{
+	Header:                 {Size: USB_STRING_LEN(1), Type: DTYPE_String},
+		
+	UnicodeString:          {LANGUAGE_ID_ENG}
+};
+
+/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form,
+ *  and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device
+ *  Descriptor.
+ */
+USB_Descriptor_String_t ProductString =
+{
+	Header:                 {Size: USB_STRING_LEN(21), Type: DTYPE_String},
+		
+	UnicodeString:          L"AVR Teensy Bootloader"
+};
+
+/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see StdDescriptors.h
+ *  documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given
+ *  to the USB library. When the device recieves a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function
+ *  is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the
+ *  USB host.
+ */
+uint16_t USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, const uint8_t wIndex, void** const DescriptorAddress)
+{
+	const uint8_t  DescriptorType   = (wValue >> 8);
+	const uint8_t  DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF);
+
+	void*    Address = NULL;
+	uint16_t Size    = NO_DESCRIPTOR;
+
+	switch (DescriptorType)
+	{
+		case DTYPE_Device:
+			Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(DeviceDescriptor);
+			Size    = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t);
+			break;
+		case DTYPE_Configuration:
+			Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(ConfigurationDescriptor);
+			Size    = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t);
+			break;
+		case DTYPE_String:
+			if (!(DescriptorNumber))
+			{
+				Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(LanguageString);
+				Size    = LanguageString.Header.Size;
+			}
+			else
+			{
+				Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(ProductString);
+				Size    = ProductString.Header.Size;
+			}
+			
+			break;
+		case DTYPE_HID:
+			Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(ConfigurationDescriptor.HIDDescriptor);
+			Size    = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_HID_t);
+			break;
+		case DTYPE_Report:
+			Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(HIDReport);
+			Size    = sizeof(HIDReport);
+			break;
+	}
+	
+	*DescriptorAddress = Address;
+	return Size;
+}
diff --git a/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/Descriptors.h b/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/Descriptors.h
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..24a0cdaa8
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/Descriptors.h
@@ -0,0 +1,91 @@
+/*
+             LUFA Library
+     Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2009.
+              
+  dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+      www.fourwalledcubicle.com
+*/
+
+/*
+  Copyright 2009  Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com)
+	  
+  Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software
+  and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby
+  granted, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all
+  copies and that both that the copyright notice and this
+  permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting
+  documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in
+  advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
+  software without specific, written prior permission.
+
+  The author disclaim all warranties with regard to this
+  software, including all implied warranties of merchantability
+  and fitness.  In no event shall the author be liable for any
+  special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages
+  whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether
+  in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action,
+  arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of
+  this software.
+*/
+
+/** \file
+ *
+ *  Header file for Descriptors.c.
+ */
+
+#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_
+#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_
+
+	/* Includes: */
+		#include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h>
+
+	/* Type Defines: */
+		/** Type define for the HID class specific HID descriptor, to describe the HID device's specifications. Refer to the HID
+		 *  specification for details on the structure elements.
+		 */	
+		typedef struct
+		{
+			USB_Descriptor_Header_t Header;
+				
+			uint16_t                HIDSpec;
+			uint8_t                 CountryCode;
+		
+			uint8_t                 TotalHIDReports;
+
+			uint8_t                 HIDReportType;
+			uint16_t                HIDReportLength;
+		} USB_Descriptor_HID_t;
+		
+		/** Type define for the data type used to store HID report descriptor elements. */
+		typedef uint8_t USB_Descriptor_HIDReport_Datatype_t;
+
+		/** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the
+		 *  application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which
+		 *  vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host.
+		 */
+		typedef struct
+		{
+			USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config;
+			USB_Descriptor_Interface_t            Interface;
+			USB_Descriptor_HID_t                  HIDDescriptor;
+	        USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t             HIDEndpoint;
+		} USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t;
+					
+	/* Macros: */
+		/** Endpoint number of the HID data IN endpoint. */
+		#define HID_EPNUM                 1
+
+		/** Size in bytes of the HID reporting IN endpoint. */		
+		#define HID_EPSIZE                64
+
+		/** Descriptor header type value, to indicate a HID class HID descriptor. */
+		#define DTYPE_HID                 0x21
+		
+		/** Descriptor header type value, to indicate a HID class HID report descriptor. */
+		#define DTYPE_Report              0x22
+
+	/* Function Prototypes: */
+		uint16_t USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, const uint8_t wIndex, void** const DescriptorAddress)
+		                           ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3);
+
+#endif
diff --git a/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/Doxygen.conf b/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/Doxygen.conf
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..0df2320ac
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/Doxygen.conf
@@ -0,0 +1,1485 @@
+# Doxyfile 1.5.7.1
+
+# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system
+# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project
+#
+# All text after a hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored
+# The format is:
+#       TAG = value [value, ...]
+# For lists items can also be appended using:
+#       TAG += value [value, ...]
+# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (" ")
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# Project related configuration options
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file 
+# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all 
+# text before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the 
+# iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See 
+# http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv for the list of possible encodings.
+
+DOXYFILE_ENCODING      = UTF-8
+
+# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded 
+# by quotes) that should identify the project.
+
+PROJECT_NAME           = "LUFA Library - Teensy HID Bootloader"
+
+# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number. 
+# This could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or 
+# if some version control system is used.
+
+PROJECT_NUMBER         = 0.0.0
+
+# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute) 
+# base path where the generated documentation will be put. 
+# If a relative path is entered, it will be relative to the location 
+# where doxygen was started. If left blank the current directory will be used.
+
+OUTPUT_DIRECTORY       = ./Documentation/
+
+# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES, then doxygen will create 
+# 4096 sub-directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output 
+# format and will distribute the generated files over these directories. 
+# Enabling this option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of 
+# source files, where putting all generated files in the same directory would 
+# otherwise cause performance problems for the file system.
+
+CREATE_SUBDIRS         = YES
+
+# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all 
+# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this 
+# information to generate all constant output in the proper language. 
+# The default language is English, other supported languages are: 
+# Afrikaans, Arabic, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, Chinese-Traditional, 
+# Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, Farsi, Finnish, French, German, Greek, 
+# Hungarian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages), 
+# Korean, Korean-en, Lithuanian, Norwegian, Macedonian, Persian, Polish, 
+# Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, Serbian, Serbian-Cyrilic, Slovak, Slovene, 
+# Spanish, Swedish, and Ukrainian.
+
+OUTPUT_LANGUAGE        = English
+
+# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will 
+# include brief member descriptions after the members that are listed in 
+# the file and class documentation (similar to JavaDoc). 
+# Set to NO to disable this.
+
+BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC      = YES
+
+# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will prepend 
+# the brief description of a member or function before the detailed description. 
+# Note: if both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the 
+# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed.
+
+REPEAT_BRIEF           = YES
+
+# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator 
+# that is used to form the text in various listings. Each string 
+# in this list, if found as the leading text of the brief description, will be 
+# stripped from the text and the result after processing the whole list, is 
+# used as the annotated text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is. 
+# If left blank, the following values are used ("$name" is automatically 
+# replaced with the name of the entity): "The $name class" "The $name widget" 
+# "The $name file" "is" "provides" "specifies" "contains" 
+# "represents" "a" "an" "the"
+
+ABBREVIATE_BRIEF       = "The $name class" \
+                         "The $name widget" \
+                         "The $name file" \
+                         is \
+                         provides \
+                         specifies \
+                         contains \
+                         represents \
+                         a \
+                         an \
+                         the
+
+# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then 
+# Doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief 
+# description.
+
+ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC    = NO
+
+# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all 
+# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those 
+# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment 
+# operators of the base classes will not be shown.
+
+INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB  = NO
+
+# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES then Doxygen will prepend the full 
+# path before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set 
+# to NO the shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used.
+
+FULL_PATH_NAMES        = YES
+
+# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES then the STRIP_FROM_PATH tag 
+# can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. Stripping is 
+# only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand part of 
+# the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list. 
+# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the 
+# path to strip.
+
+STRIP_FROM_PATH        = 
+
+# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of 
+# the path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells 
+# the reader which header file to include in order to use a class. 
+# If left blank only the name of the header file containing the class 
+# definition is used. Otherwise one should specify the include paths that 
+# are normally passed to the compiler using the -I flag.
+
+STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH    = 
+
+# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter 
+# (but less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems 
+# doesn't support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM.
+
+SHORT_NAMES            = YES
+
+# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then Doxygen 
+# will interpret the first line (until the first dot) of a JavaDoc-style 
+# comment as the brief description. If set to NO, the JavaDoc 
+# comments will behave just like regular Qt-style comments 
+# (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief description.)
+
+JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF      = NO
+
+# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then Doxygen will 
+# interpret the first line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style 
+# comment as the brief description. If set to NO, the comments 
+# will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus requiring 
+# an explicit \brief command for a brief description.)
+
+QT_AUTOBRIEF           = NO
+
+# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make Doxygen 
+# treat a multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or /// 
+# comments) as a brief description. This used to be the default behaviour. 
+# The new default is to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed 
+# description. Set this tag to YES if you prefer the old behaviour instead.
+
+MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO
+
+# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES (the default) then an undocumented 
+# member inherits the documentation from any documented member that it 
+# re-implements.
+
+INHERIT_DOCS           = YES
+
+# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES, then doxygen will produce 
+# a new page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will 
+# be part of the file/class/namespace that contains it.
+
+SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES  = NO
+
+# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab. 
+# Doxygen uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments.
+
+TAB_SIZE               = 4
+
+# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that acts 
+# as commands in the documentation. An alias has the form "name=value". 
+# For example adding "sideeffect=\par Side Effects:\n" will allow you to 
+# put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the documentation, which 
+# will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading "Side Effects:". 
+# You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert newlines.
+
+ALIASES                = 
+
+# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C 
+# sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C. 
+# For instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list 
+# of all members will be omitted, etc.
+
+OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C  = YES
+
+# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java 
+# sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for 
+# Java. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, qualified 
+# scopes will look different, etc.
+
+OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA   = NO
+
+# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran 
+# sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for 
+# Fortran.
+
+OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN   = NO
+
+# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL 
+# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for 
+# VHDL.
+
+OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL   = NO
+
+# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want 
+# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should 
+# set this tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and 
+# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); v.s. 
+# func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration 
+# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate.
+
+BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT    = NO
+
+# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to
+# enable parsing support.
+
+CPP_CLI_SUPPORT        = NO
+
+# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip sources only. 
+# Doxygen will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public 
+# instead of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present.
+
+SIP_SUPPORT            = NO
+
+# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate getter 
+# and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES (the default) 
+# will make doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the 
+# documentation. This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or 
+# setting a simple type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the 
+# methods anyway, you should set this option to NO.
+
+IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT   = YES
+
+# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC 
+# tag is set to YES, then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first 
+# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default 
+# all members of a group must be documented explicitly.
+
+DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC   = NO
+
+# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES (the default) to allow class member groups of 
+# the same type (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a 
+# subgroup of that type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to 
+# NO to prevent subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using 
+# the \nosubgrouping command.
+
+SUBGROUPING            = YES
+
+# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or enum 
+# is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So 
+# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct 
+# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file, 
+# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically 
+# be useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound 
+# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name.
+
+TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT   = NO
+
+# The SYMBOL_CACHE_SIZE determines the size of the internal cache use to 
+# determine which symbols to keep in memory and which to flush to disk.
+# When the cache is full, less often used symbols will be written to disk.
+# For small to medium size projects (<1000 input files) the default value is 
+# probably good enough. For larger projects a too small cache size can cause 
+# doxygen to be busy swapping symbols to and from disk most of the time 
+# causing a significant performance penality. 
+# If the system has enough physical memory increasing the cache will improve the 
+# performance by keeping more symbols in memory. Note that the value works on 
+# a logarithmic scale so increasing the size by one will rougly double the 
+# memory usage. The cache size is given by this formula: 
+# 2^(16+SYMBOL_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range is 0..9, the default is 0, 
+# corresponding to a cache size of 2^16 = 65536 symbols
+
+SYMBOL_CACHE_SIZE      = 0
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# Build related configuration options
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES doxygen will assume all entities in 
+# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available. 
+# Private class members and static file members will be hidden unless 
+# the EXTRACT_PRIVATE and EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES
+
+EXTRACT_ALL            = YES
+
+# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES all private members of a class 
+# will be included in the documentation.
+
+EXTRACT_PRIVATE        = YES
+
+# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES all static members of a file 
+# will be included in the documentation.
+
+EXTRACT_STATIC         = YES
+
+# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES classes (and structs) 
+# defined locally in source files will be included in the documentation. 
+# If set to NO only classes defined in header files are included.
+
+EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES  = YES
+
+# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. When set to YES local 
+# methods, which are defined in the implementation section but not in 
+# the interface are included in the documentation. 
+# If set to NO (the default) only methods in the interface are included.
+
+EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS  = NO
+
+# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be 
+# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called 
+# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base 
+# name of the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default 
+# anonymous namespace are hidden.
+
+EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES   = NO
+
+# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, Doxygen will hide all 
+# undocumented members of documented classes, files or namespaces. 
+# If set to NO (the default) these members will be included in the 
+# various overviews, but no documentation section is generated. 
+# This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled.
+
+HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS     = NO
+
+# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, Doxygen will hide all 
+# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy. 
+# If set to NO (the default) these classes will be included in the various 
+# overviews. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled.
+
+HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES     = NO
+
+# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, Doxygen will hide all 
+# friend (class|struct|union) declarations. 
+# If set to NO (the default) these declarations will be included in the 
+# documentation.
+
+HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS  = NO
+
+# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, Doxygen will hide any 
+# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function. 
+# If set to NO (the default) these blocks will be appended to the 
+# function's detailed documentation block.
+
+HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS      = NO
+
+# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation 
+# that is typed after a \internal command is included. If the tag is set 
+# to NO (the default) then the documentation will be excluded. 
+# Set it to YES to include the internal documentation.
+
+INTERNAL_DOCS          = NO
+
+# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then Doxygen will only generate 
+# file names in lower-case letters. If set to YES upper-case letters are also 
+# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ 
+# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows 
+# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO.
+
+CASE_SENSE_NAMES       = NO
+
+# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO (the default) then Doxygen 
+# will show members with their full class and namespace scopes in the 
+# documentation. If set to YES the scope will be hidden.
+
+HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES       = NO
+
+# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES (the default) then Doxygen 
+# will put a list of the files that are included by a file in the documentation 
+# of that file.
+
+SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES     = YES
+
+# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES (the default) then a tag [inline] 
+# is inserted in the documentation for inline members.
+
+INLINE_INFO            = YES
+
+# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES (the default) then doxygen 
+# will sort the (detailed) documentation of file and class members 
+# alphabetically by member name. If set to NO the members will appear in 
+# declaration order.
+
+SORT_MEMBER_DOCS       = YES
+
+# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the 
+# brief documentation of file, namespace and class members alphabetically 
+# by member name. If set to NO (the default) the members will appear in 
+# declaration order.
+
+SORT_BRIEF_DOCS        = NO
+
+# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the 
+# hierarchy of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO (the default) 
+# the group names will appear in their defined order.
+
+SORT_GROUP_NAMES       = NO
+
+# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be 
+# sorted by fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to 
+# NO (the default), the class list will be sorted only by class name, 
+# not including the namespace part. 
+# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES.
+# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the 
+# alphabetical list.
+
+SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME     = NO
+
+# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or 
+# disable (NO) the todo list. This list is created by putting \todo 
+# commands in the documentation.
+
+GENERATE_TODOLIST      = NO
+
+# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or 
+# disable (NO) the test list. This list is created by putting \test 
+# commands in the documentation.
+
+GENERATE_TESTLIST      = NO
+
+# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or 
+# disable (NO) the bug list. This list is created by putting \bug 
+# commands in the documentation.
+
+GENERATE_BUGLIST       = NO
+
+# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or 
+# disable (NO) the deprecated list. This list is created by putting 
+# \deprecated commands in the documentation.
+
+GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES
+
+# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional 
+# documentation sections, marked by \if sectionname ... \endif.
+
+ENABLED_SECTIONS       = 
+
+# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines 
+# the initial value of a variable or define consists of for it to appear in 
+# the documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified 
+# here it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely. 
+# The appearance of the initializer of individual variables and defines in the 
+# documentation can be controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer 
+# command in the documentation regardless of this setting.
+
+MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES  = 30
+
+# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated 
+# at the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES the 
+# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation.
+
+SHOW_USED_FILES        = YES
+
+# If the sources in your project are distributed over multiple directories 
+# then setting the SHOW_DIRECTORIES tag to YES will show the directory hierarchy 
+# in the documentation. The default is NO.
+
+SHOW_DIRECTORIES       = YES
+
+# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page.
+# This will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the 
+# Folder Tree View (if specified). The default is YES.
+
+SHOW_FILES             = YES
+
+# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the 
+# Namespaces page.  This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index
+# and from the Folder Tree View (if specified). The default is YES.
+
+SHOW_NAMESPACES        = YES
+
+# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that 
+# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from 
+# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via 
+# popen()) the command <command> <input-file>, where <command> is the value of 
+# the FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the name of an input file 
+# provided by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output 
+# is used as the file version. See the manual for examples.
+
+FILE_VERSION_FILTER    = 
+
+# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed by 
+# doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated output files 
+# in an output format independent way. The create the layout file that represents 
+# doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can optionally specify a 
+# file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml will be used as the name 
+# of the layout file.
+
+LAYOUT_FILE            = 
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to warning and progress messages
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated 
+# by doxygen. Possible values are YES and NO. If left blank NO is used.
+
+QUIET                  = YES
+
+# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are 
+# generated by doxygen. Possible values are YES and NO. If left blank 
+# NO is used.
+
+WARNINGS               = YES
+
+# If WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED is set to YES, then doxygen will generate warnings 
+# for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag will 
+# automatically be disabled.
+
+WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED   = YES
+
+# If WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for 
+# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some 
+# parameters in a documented function, or documenting parameters that 
+# don't exist or using markup commands wrongly.
+
+WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR      = YES
+
+# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be abled to get warnings for 
+# functions that are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters 
+# or return value. If set to NO (the default) doxygen will only warn about 
+# wrong or incomplete parameter documentation, but not about the absence of 
+# documentation.
+
+WARN_NO_PARAMDOC       = YES
+
+# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that 
+# doxygen can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text 
+# tags, which will be replaced by the file and line number from which the 
+# warning originated and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain 
+# $version, which will be replaced by the version of the file (if it could 
+# be obtained via FILE_VERSION_FILTER)
+
+WARN_FORMAT            = "$file:$line: $text"
+
+# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning 
+# and error messages should be written. If left blank the output is written 
+# to stderr.
+
+WARN_LOGFILE           = 
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the input files
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# The INPUT tag can be used to specify the files and/or directories that contain 
+# documented source files. You may enter file names like "myfile.cpp" or 
+# directories like "/usr/src/myproject". Separate the files or directories 
+# with spaces.
+
+INPUT                  = ./
+
+# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files 
+# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding, which is 
+# also the default input encoding. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv built 
+# into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv for 
+# the list of possible encodings.
+
+INPUT_ENCODING         = UTF-8
+
+# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the 
+# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp 
+# and *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left 
+# blank the following patterns are tested: 
+# *.c *.cc *.cxx *.cpp *.c++ *.java *.ii *.ixx *.ipp *.i++ *.inl *.h *.hh *.hxx 
+# *.hpp *.h++ *.idl *.odl *.cs *.php *.php3 *.inc *.m *.mm *.py *.f90
+
+FILE_PATTERNS          = *.h \
+                         *.c \
+						 *.txt
+
+# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to turn specify whether or not subdirectories 
+# should be searched for input files as well. Possible values are YES and NO. 
+# If left blank NO is used.
+
+RECURSIVE              = YES
+
+# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should 
+# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a 
+# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag.
+
+EXCLUDE                = 
+
+# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used select whether or not files or 
+# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix filesystem feature) are excluded 
+# from the input.
+
+EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS       = NO
+
+# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the 
+# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude 
+# certain files from those directories. Note that the wildcards are matched 
+# against the file with absolute path, so to exclude all test directories 
+# for example use the pattern */test/*
+
+EXCLUDE_PATTERNS       = */LowLevel/USBMode.h
+
+# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names 
+# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the 
+# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the 
+# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass, 
+# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test
+
+EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS        = __*
+
+# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or 
+# directories that contain example code fragments that are included (see 
+# the \include command).
+
+EXAMPLE_PATH           = 
+
+# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the 
+# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp 
+# and *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left 
+# blank all files are included.
+
+EXAMPLE_PATTERNS       = *
+
+# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be 
+# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude 
+# commands irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag. 
+# Possible values are YES and NO. If left blank NO is used.
+
+EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE      = NO
+
+# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or 
+# directories that contain image that are included in the documentation (see 
+# the \image command).
+
+IMAGE_PATH             = 
+
+# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should 
+# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program 
+# by executing (via popen()) the command <filter> <input-file>, where <filter> 
+# is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the name of an 
+# input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter program writes 
+# to standard output.  If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag will be 
+# ignored.
+
+INPUT_FILTER           = 
+
+# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern 
+# basis.  Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the 
+# filter if there is a match.  The filters are a list of the form: 
+# pattern=filter (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further 
+# info on how filters are used. If FILTER_PATTERNS is empty, INPUT_FILTER 
+# is applied to all files.
+
+FILTER_PATTERNS        = 
+
+# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using 
+# INPUT_FILTER) will be used to filter the input files when producing source 
+# files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES).
+
+FILTER_SOURCE_FILES    = NO
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to source browsing
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will 
+# be generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources. 
+# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure also 
+# VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO.
+
+SOURCE_BROWSER         = NO
+
+# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body 
+# of functions and classes directly in the documentation.
+
+INLINE_SOURCES         = NO
+
+# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES (the default) will instruct 
+# doxygen to hide any special comment blocks from generated source code 
+# fragments. Normal C and C++ comments will always remain visible.
+
+STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS    = YES
+
+# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES 
+# then for each documented function all documented 
+# functions referencing it will be listed.
+
+REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO
+
+# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES 
+# then for each documented function all documented entities 
+# called/used by that function will be listed.
+
+REFERENCES_RELATION    = NO
+
+# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES (the default)
+# and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES, then the hyperlinks from
+# functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will
+# link to the source code.  Otherwise they will link to the documentstion.
+
+REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO
+
+# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code 
+# will point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen 
+# built-in source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source 
+# tagging system (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You 
+# will need version 4.8.6 or higher.
+
+USE_HTAGS              = NO
+
+# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set to YES (the default) then Doxygen 
+# will generate a verbatim copy of the header file for each class for 
+# which an include is specified. Set to NO to disable this.
+
+VERBATIM_HEADERS       = NO
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the alphabetical class index
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index 
+# of all compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project 
+# contains a lot of classes, structs, unions or interfaces.
+
+ALPHABETICAL_INDEX     = YES
+
+# If the alphabetical index is enabled (see ALPHABETICAL_INDEX) then 
+# the COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns 
+# in which this list will be split (can be a number in the range [1..20])
+
+COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX    = 5
+
+# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all 
+# classes will be put under the same header in the alphabetical index. 
+# The IGNORE_PREFIX tag can be used to specify one or more prefixes that 
+# should be ignored while generating the index headers.
+
+IGNORE_PREFIX          = 
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the HTML output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will 
+# generate HTML output.
+
+GENERATE_HTML          = YES
+
+# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put. 
+# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be 
+# put in front of it. If left blank `html' will be used as the default path.
+
+HTML_OUTPUT            = html
+
+# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for 
+# each generated HTML page (for example: .htm,.php,.asp). If it is left blank 
+# doxygen will generate files with .html extension.
+
+HTML_FILE_EXTENSION    = .html
+
+# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal HTML header for 
+# each generated HTML page. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a 
+# standard header.
+
+HTML_HEADER            = 
+
+# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal HTML footer for 
+# each generated HTML page. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a 
+# standard footer.
+
+HTML_FOOTER            = 
+
+# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading 
+# style sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to 
+# fine-tune the look of the HTML output. If the tag is left blank doxygen 
+# will generate a default style sheet. Note that doxygen will try to copy 
+# the style sheet file to the HTML output directory, so don't put your own 
+# stylesheet in the HTML output directory as well, or it will be erased!
+
+HTML_STYLESHEET        = 
+
+# If the HTML_ALIGN_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, the members of classes, 
+# files or namespaces will be aligned in HTML using tables. If set to 
+# NO a bullet list will be used.
+
+HTML_ALIGN_MEMBERS     = YES
+
+# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML 
+# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the 
+# page has loaded. For this to work a browser that supports 
+# JavaScript and DHTML is required (for instance Mozilla 1.0+, Firefox 
+# Netscape 6.0+, Internet explorer 5.0+, Konqueror, or Safari).
+
+HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS  = YES
+
+# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files 
+# will be generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3 
+# integrated development environment, introduced with OSX 10.5 (Leopard). 
+# To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a Makefile in the 
+# HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in that 
+# directory and running "make install" will install the docset in 
+# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find 
+# it at startup. 
+# See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html for more information.
+
+GENERATE_DOCSET        = NO
+
+# When GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, this tag determines the name of the 
+# feed. A documentation feed provides an umbrella under which multiple 
+# documentation sets from a single provider (such as a company or product suite) 
+# can be grouped.
+
+DOCSET_FEEDNAME        = "Doxygen generated docs"
+
+# When GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, this tag specifies a string that 
+# should uniquely identify the documentation set bundle. This should be a 
+# reverse domain-name style string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen 
+# will append .docset to the name.
+
+DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID       = org.doxygen.Project
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files 
+# will be generated that can be used as input for tools like the 
+# Microsoft HTML help workshop to generate a compiled HTML help file (.chm) 
+# of the generated HTML documentation.
+
+GENERATE_HTMLHELP      = NO
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the CHM_FILE tag can 
+# be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm file. You 
+# can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be 
+# written to the html output directory.
+
+CHM_FILE               = 
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the HHC_LOCATION tag can 
+# be used to specify the location (absolute path including file name) of 
+# the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty doxygen will try to run 
+# the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp.
+
+HHC_LOCATION           = 
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the GENERATE_CHI flag 
+# controls if a separate .chi index file is generated (YES) or that 
+# it should be included in the master .chm file (NO).
+
+GENERATE_CHI           = NO
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the CHM_INDEX_ENCODING
+# is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) and project file
+# content.
+
+CHM_INDEX_ENCODING     = 
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the BINARY_TOC flag 
+# controls whether a binary table of contents is generated (YES) or a 
+# normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file.
+
+BINARY_TOC             = NO
+
+# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members 
+# to the contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view.
+
+TOC_EXPAND             = YES
+
+# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER 
+# are set, an additional index file will be generated that can be used as input for 
+# Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help (.qch) of the generated 
+# HTML documentation.
+
+GENERATE_QHP           = NO
+
+# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can 
+# be used to specify the file name of the resulting .qch file. 
+# The path specified is relative to the HTML output folder.
+
+QCH_FILE               = 
+
+# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating 
+# Qt Help Project output. For more information please see 
+# <a href="http://doc.trolltech.com/qthelpproject.html#namespace">Qt Help Project / Namespace</a>.
+
+QHP_NAMESPACE          = org.doxygen.Project
+
+# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating 
+# Qt Help Project output. For more information please see 
+# <a href="http://doc.trolltech.com/qthelpproject.html#virtual-folders">Qt Help Project / Virtual Folders</a>.
+
+QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER     = doc
+
+# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES, the QHG_LOCATION tag can 
+# be used to specify the location of Qt's qhelpgenerator. 
+# If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the generated 
+# .qhp file .
+
+QHG_LOCATION           = 
+
+# The DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index at 
+# top of each HTML page. The value NO (the default) enables the index and 
+# the value YES disables it.
+
+DISABLE_INDEX          = NO
+
+# This tag can be used to set the number of enum values (range [1..20]) 
+# that doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation.
+
+ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE   = 1
+
+# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index
+# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information.
+# If the tag value is set to FRAME, a side panel will be generated
+# containing a tree-like index structure (just like the one that 
+# is generated for HTML Help). For this to work a browser that supports 
+# JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required (for instance Mozilla 1.0+, 
+# Netscape 6.0+, Internet explorer 5.0+, or Konqueror). Windows users are 
+# probably better off using the HTML help feature. Other possible values 
+# for this tag are: HIERARCHIES, which will generate the Groups, Directories,
+# and Class Hierarchy pages using a tree view instead of an ordered list;
+# ALL, which combines the behavior of FRAME and HIERARCHIES; and NONE, which
+# disables this behavior completely. For backwards compatibility with previous
+# releases of Doxygen, the values YES and NO are equivalent to FRAME and NONE
+# respectively.
+
+GENERATE_TREEVIEW      = YES
+
+# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be 
+# used to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree 
+# is shown.
+
+TREEVIEW_WIDTH         = 250
+
+# Use this tag to change the font size of Latex formulas included 
+# as images in the HTML documentation. The default is 10. Note that 
+# when you change the font size after a successful doxygen run you need 
+# to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML output directory 
+# to force them to be regenerated.
+
+FORMULA_FONTSIZE       = 10
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the LaTeX output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will 
+# generate Latex output.
+
+GENERATE_LATEX         = NO
+
+# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put. 
+# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be 
+# put in front of it. If left blank `latex' will be used as the default path.
+
+LATEX_OUTPUT           = latex
+
+# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be 
+# invoked. If left blank `latex' will be used as the default command name.
+
+LATEX_CMD_NAME         = latex
+
+# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to 
+# generate index for LaTeX. If left blank `makeindex' will be used as the 
+# default command name.
+
+MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME     = makeindex
+
+# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES Doxygen generates more compact 
+# LaTeX documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to 
+# save some trees in general.
+
+COMPACT_LATEX          = NO
+
+# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used 
+# by the printer. Possible values are: a4, a4wide, letter, legal and 
+# executive. If left blank a4wide will be used.
+
+PAPER_TYPE             = a4wide
+
+# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be to specify one or more names of LaTeX 
+# packages that should be included in the LaTeX output.
+
+EXTRA_PACKAGES         = 
+
+# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for 
+# the generated latex document. The header should contain everything until 
+# the first chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a 
+# standard header. Notice: only use this tag if you know what you are doing!
+
+LATEX_HEADER           = 
+
+# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated 
+# is prepared for conversion to pdf (using ps2pdf). The pdf file will 
+# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references 
+# This makes the output suitable for online browsing using a pdf viewer.
+
+PDF_HYPERLINKS         = YES
+
+# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, pdflatex will be used instead of 
+# plain latex in the generated Makefile. Set this option to YES to get a 
+# higher quality PDF documentation.
+
+USE_PDFLATEX           = YES
+
+# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \\batchmode. 
+# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep 
+# running if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help. 
+# This option is also used when generating formulas in HTML.
+
+LATEX_BATCHMODE        = NO
+
+# If LATEX_HIDE_INDICES is set to YES then doxygen will not 
+# include the index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.) 
+# in the output.
+
+LATEX_HIDE_INDICES     = NO
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the RTF output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES Doxygen will generate RTF output 
+# The RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look very pretty with 
+# other RTF readers or editors.
+
+GENERATE_RTF           = NO
+
+# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put. 
+# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be 
+# put in front of it. If left blank `rtf' will be used as the default path.
+
+RTF_OUTPUT             = rtf
+
+# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES Doxygen generates more compact 
+# RTF documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to 
+# save some trees in general.
+
+COMPACT_RTF            = NO
+
+# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated 
+# will contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will 
+# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references. 
+# This makes the output suitable for online browsing using WORD or other 
+# programs which support those fields. 
+# Note: wordpad (write) and others do not support links.
+
+RTF_HYPERLINKS         = NO
+
+# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's 
+# config file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide 
+# replacements, missing definitions are set to their default value.
+
+RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE    = 
+
+# Set optional variables used in the generation of an rtf document. 
+# Syntax is similar to doxygen's config file.
+
+RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE    = 
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the man page output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will 
+# generate man pages
+
+GENERATE_MAN           = NO
+
+# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put. 
+# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be 
+# put in front of it. If left blank `man' will be used as the default path.
+
+MAN_OUTPUT             = man
+
+# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to 
+# the generated man pages (default is the subroutine's section .3)
+
+MAN_EXTENSION          = .3
+
+# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and Doxygen generates man output, 
+# then it will generate one additional man file for each entity 
+# documented in the real man page(s). These additional files 
+# only source the real man page, but without them the man command 
+# would be unable to find the correct page. The default is NO.
+
+MAN_LINKS              = NO
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the XML output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES Doxygen will 
+# generate an XML file that captures the structure of 
+# the code including all documentation.
+
+GENERATE_XML           = NO
+
+# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put. 
+# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be 
+# put in front of it. If left blank `xml' will be used as the default path.
+
+XML_OUTPUT             = xml
+
+# The XML_SCHEMA tag can be used to specify an XML schema, 
+# which can be used by a validating XML parser to check the 
+# syntax of the XML files.
+
+XML_SCHEMA             = 
+
+# The XML_DTD tag can be used to specify an XML DTD, 
+# which can be used by a validating XML parser to check the 
+# syntax of the XML files.
+
+XML_DTD                = 
+
+# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES Doxygen will 
+# dump the program listings (including syntax highlighting 
+# and cross-referencing information) to the XML output. Note that 
+# enabling this will significantly increase the size of the XML output.
+
+XML_PROGRAMLISTING     = YES
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES Doxygen will 
+# generate an AutoGen Definitions (see autogen.sf.net) file 
+# that captures the structure of the code including all 
+# documentation. Note that this feature is still experimental 
+# and incomplete at the moment.
+
+GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF   = NO
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the Perl module output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES Doxygen will 
+# generate a Perl module file that captures the structure of 
+# the code including all documentation. Note that this 
+# feature is still experimental and incomplete at the 
+# moment.
+
+GENERATE_PERLMOD       = NO
+
+# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES Doxygen will generate 
+# the necessary Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able 
+# to generate PDF and DVI output from the Perl module output.
+
+PERLMOD_LATEX          = NO
+
+# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES the Perl module output will be 
+# nicely formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader.  This is useful 
+# if you want to understand what is going on.  On the other hand, if this 
+# tag is set to NO the size of the Perl module output will be much smaller 
+# and Perl will parse it just the same.
+
+PERLMOD_PRETTY         = YES
+
+# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file 
+# are prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX. 
+# This is useful so different doxyrules.make files included by the same 
+# Makefile don't overwrite each other's variables.
+
+PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX = 
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# Configuration options related to the preprocessor   
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will 
+# evaluate all C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include 
+# files.
+
+ENABLE_PREPROCESSING   = YES
+
+# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES Doxygen will expand all macro 
+# names in the source code. If set to NO (the default) only conditional 
+# compilation will be performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled 
+# way by setting EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES.
+
+MACRO_EXPANSION        = YES
+
+# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES 
+# then the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the 
+# PREDEFINED and EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags.
+
+EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF     = YES
+
+# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES (the default) the includes files 
+# in the INCLUDE_PATH (see below) will be search if a #include is found.
+
+SEARCH_INCLUDES        = YES
+
+# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that 
+# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by 
+# the preprocessor.
+
+INCLUDE_PATH           = 
+
+# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard 
+# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the 
+# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will 
+# be used.
+
+INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS  = 
+
+# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that 
+# are defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of 
+# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name 
+# or name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the = are 
+# omitted =1 is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being 
+# undefined via #undef or recursively expanded use the := operator 
+# instead of the = operator.
+
+PREDEFINED             = __DOXYGEN__
+
+# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then 
+# this tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded. 
+# The macro definition that is found in the sources will be used. 
+# Use the PREDEFINED tag if you want to use a different macro definition.
+
+EXPAND_AS_DEFINED      = BUTTLOADTAG
+
+# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES (the default) then 
+# doxygen's preprocessor will remove all function-like macros that are alone 
+# on a line, have an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such 
+# function macros are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse 
+# the parser if not removed.
+
+SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS   = YES
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# Configuration::additions related to external references   
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# The TAGFILES option can be used to specify one or more tagfiles. 
+# Optionally an initial location of the external documentation 
+# can be added for each tagfile. The format of a tag file without 
+# this location is as follows: 
+#   TAGFILES = file1 file2 ... 
+# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows: 
+#   TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ... 
+# where "loc1" and "loc2" can be relative or absolute paths or 
+# URLs. If a location is present for each tag, the installdox tool 
+# does not have to be run to correct the links.
+# Note that each tag file must have a unique name
+# (where the name does NOT include the path)
+# If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen 
+# is run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here.
+
+TAGFILES               = 
+
+# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create 
+# a tag file that is based on the input files it reads.
+
+GENERATE_TAGFILE       = 
+
+# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES all external classes will be listed 
+# in the class index. If set to NO only the inherited external classes 
+# will be listed.
+
+ALLEXTERNALS           = NO
+
+# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES all external groups will be listed 
+# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will 
+# be listed.
+
+EXTERNAL_GROUPS        = YES
+
+# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script 
+# interpreter (i.e. the result of `which perl').
+
+PERL_PATH              = /usr/bin/perl
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# Configuration options related to the dot tool   
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will 
+# generate a inheritance diagram (in HTML, RTF and LaTeX) for classes with base 
+# or super classes. Setting the tag to NO turns the diagrams off. Note that 
+# this option is superseded by the HAVE_DOT option below. This is only a 
+# fallback. It is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more 
+# powerful graphs.
+
+CLASS_DIAGRAMS         = NO
+
+# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc 
+# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see 
+# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/) to produce the chart and insert it in the 
+# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where 
+# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the 
+# default search path.
+
+MSCGEN_PATH            = 
+
+# If set to YES, the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide 
+# inheritance and usage relations if the target is undocumented 
+# or is not a class.
+
+HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS   = YES
+
+# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is 
+# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz, a graph visualization 
+# toolkit from AT&T and Lucent Bell Labs. The other options in this section 
+# have no effect if this option is set to NO (the default)
+
+HAVE_DOT               = NO
+
+# By default doxygen will write a font called FreeSans.ttf to the output 
+# directory and reference it in all dot files that doxygen generates. This 
+# font does not include all possible unicode characters however, so when you need 
+# these (or just want a differently looking font) you can specify the font name 
+# using DOT_FONTNAME. You need need to make sure dot is able to find the font, 
+# which can be done by putting it in a standard location or by setting the 
+# DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory 
+# containing the font.
+
+DOT_FONTNAME           = FreeSans
+
+# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size of the font of dot graphs. 
+# The default size is 10pt.
+
+DOT_FONTSIZE           = 10
+
+# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the output directory to look for the 
+# FreeSans.ttf font (which doxygen will put there itself). If you specify a 
+# different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set the path where dot 
+# can find it using this tag.
+
+DOT_FONTPATH           = 
+
+# If the CLASS_GRAPH and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen 
+# will generate a graph for each documented class showing the direct and 
+# indirect inheritance relations. Setting this tag to YES will force the 
+# the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO.
+
+CLASS_GRAPH            = NO
+
+# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen 
+# will generate a graph for each documented class showing the direct and 
+# indirect implementation dependencies (inheritance, containment, and 
+# class references variables) of the class with other documented classes.
+
+COLLABORATION_GRAPH    = NO
+
+# If the GROUP_GRAPHS and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen 
+# will generate a graph for groups, showing the direct groups dependencies
+
+GROUP_GRAPHS           = NO
+
+# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES doxygen will generate inheritance and 
+# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling 
+# Language.
+
+UML_LOOK               = NO
+
+# If set to YES, the inheritance and collaboration graphs will show the 
+# relations between templates and their instances.
+
+TEMPLATE_RELATIONS     = NO
+
+# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING, SEARCH_INCLUDES, INCLUDE_GRAPH, and HAVE_DOT 
+# tags are set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented 
+# file showing the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with 
+# other documented files.
+
+INCLUDE_GRAPH          = NO
+
+# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING, SEARCH_INCLUDES, INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, and 
+# HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each 
+# documented header file showing the documented files that directly or 
+# indirectly include this file.
+
+INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH      = NO
+
+# If the CALL_GRAPH and HAVE_DOT options are set to YES then 
+# doxygen will generate a call dependency graph for every global function 
+# or class method. Note that enabling this option will significantly increase 
+# the time of a run. So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs 
+# for selected functions only using the \callgraph command.
+
+CALL_GRAPH             = NO
+
+# If the CALLER_GRAPH and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then 
+# doxygen will generate a caller dependency graph for every global function 
+# or class method. Note that enabling this option will significantly increase 
+# the time of a run. So in most cases it will be better to enable caller 
+# graphs for selected functions only using the \callergraph command.
+
+CALLER_GRAPH           = NO
+
+# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen 
+# will graphical hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one.
+
+GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY    = NO
+
+# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH, SHOW_DIRECTORIES and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES 
+# then doxygen will show the dependencies a directory has on other directories 
+# in a graphical way. The dependency relations are determined by the #include
+# relations between the files in the directories.
+
+DIRECTORY_GRAPH        = NO
+
+# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images 
+# generated by dot. Possible values are png, jpg, or gif
+# If left blank png will be used.
+
+DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT       = png
+
+# The tag DOT_PATH can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be 
+# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path.
+
+DOT_PATH               = "C:/Program Files/Graphviz2.18/bin"
+
+# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that 
+# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the 
+# \dotfile command).
+
+DOTFILE_DIRS           = 
+
+# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of 
+# nodes that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph 
+# becomes larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is 
+# visualized by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the 
+# number of direct children of the root node in a graph is already larger than 
+# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note 
+# that the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH.
+
+DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES    = 15
+
+# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the 
+# graphs generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable 
+# from the root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes 
+# that lay further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this 
+# option to 1 or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large 
+# code bases. Also note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by 
+# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction.
+
+MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH    = 2
+
+# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent 
+# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not 
+# seem to support this out of the box. Warning: Depending on the platform used, 
+# enabling this option may lead to badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of 
+# a graph (i.e. they become hard to read).
+
+DOT_TRANSPARENT        = YES
+
+# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES allow dot to generate multiple output 
+# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This 
+# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10) 
+# support this, this feature is disabled by default.
+
+DOT_MULTI_TARGETS      = NO
+
+# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will 
+# generate a legend page explaining the meaning of the various boxes and 
+# arrows in the dot generated graphs.
+
+GENERATE_LEGEND        = YES
+
+# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will 
+# remove the intermediate dot files that are used to generate 
+# the various graphs.
+
+DOT_CLEANUP            = YES
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# Configuration::additions related to the search engine   
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# The SEARCHENGINE tag specifies whether or not a search engine should be 
+# used. If set to NO the values of all tags below this one will be ignored.
+
+SEARCHENGINE           = NO
diff --git a/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/TeensyHID.c b/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/TeensyHID.c
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..4f09ac50b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/TeensyHID.c
@@ -0,0 +1,156 @@
+/*
+             LUFA Library
+     Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2009.
+              
+  dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+      www.fourwalledcubicle.com
+*/
+
+/*
+  Copyright 2009  Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com)
+
+  Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software
+  and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby
+  granted, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all
+  copies and that both that the copyright notice and this
+  permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting
+  documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in
+  advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
+  software without specific, written prior permission.
+
+  The author disclaim all warranties with regard to this
+  software, including all implied warranties of merchantability
+  and fitness.  In no event shall the author be liable for any
+  special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages
+  whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether
+  in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action,
+  arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of
+  this software.
+*/
+
+/** \file
+ *
+ *  Main source file for the TeensyHID bootloader. This file contains the complete bootloader logic.
+ */
+ 
+#define  INCLUDE_FROM_TEENSYHID_C
+#include "TeensyHID.h"
+
+/* Global Variables: */
+/** Flag to indicate if the bootloader should be running, or should exit and allow the application code to run
+ *  via a soft reset. When cleared, the bootloader will abort, the USB interface will shut down and the application
+ *  started via a forced watchdog reset.
+ */
+bool RunBootloader = true;
+
+
+/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the bootloader, then continuously 
+ *  runs the bootloader processing routine until instructed to soft-exit.
+ */
+int main(void)
+{
+	/* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */
+	MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF);
+	wdt_disable();
+
+	/* Disable Clock Division */
+	SetSystemClockPrescaler(0);
+
+	/* Relocate the interrupt vector table to the bootloader section */
+	MCUCR = (1 << IVCE);
+	MCUCR = (1 << IVSEL);
+
+	/* Initialize USB subsystem */
+	USB_Init();
+	
+	while (RunBootloader)
+	  USB_USBTask();
+	  
+	/* Shut down the USB interface, so that the host will register the disconnection */
+	USB_ShutDown();
+
+	/* Wait 100ms to give the host time to register the disconnection */
+	_delay_ms(100);
+
+	/* Enable the watchdog and force a timeout to reset the AVR */
+	wdt_enable(WDTO_250MS);
+					
+	for (;;);
+}
+
+/** Event handler for the USB_ConfigurationChanged event. This configures the device's endpoints ready
+ *  to relay data to and from the attached USB host.
+ */
+EVENT_HANDLER(USB_ConfigurationChanged)
+{
+	/* Setup HID Report Endpoint */
+	Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(HID_EPNUM, EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT,
+		                       ENDPOINT_DIR_IN, HID_EPSIZE,
+	                           ENDPOINT_BANK_SINGLE);
+}
+
+/** Event handler for the USB_UnhandledControlPacket event. This is used to catch standard and class specific
+ *  control requests that are not handled internally by the USB library (including the HID commands, which are
+ *  all issued via the control endpoint), so that they can be handled appropriately for the application.
+ */
+EVENT_HANDLER(USB_UnhandledControlPacket)
+{
+	/* Handle HID Class specific requests */
+	switch (bRequest)
+	{
+		case REQ_SetReport:
+			if (bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE))
+			{
+				Endpoint_ClearSetupReceived();
+				
+				/* Wait until the command (report) has been sent by the host */
+				while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupOUTReceived()));
+
+				/* Read in the write destination address */
+				uint16_t PageAddress = Endpoint_Read_Word_LE();
+				
+				/* Check if the command is a program page command, or a start application command */
+				if (PageAddress == TEENSY_STARTAPPLICATION)
+				{
+					RunBootloader = false;
+				}
+				else
+				{
+					/* Erase the given FLASH page, ready to be programmed */
+					boot_page_erase(PageAddress);
+					boot_spm_busy_wait();
+					
+					/* Write each of the FLASH page's bytes in sequence */
+					for (uint8_t PageByte = 0; PageByte < 128; PageByte += 2)
+					{
+						/* Check if endpoint is empty - if so clear it and wait until ready for next packet */
+						if (!(Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint()))
+						{
+							Endpoint_ClearSetupOUT();
+							while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupOUTReceived()));
+						}
+
+						/* Write the next data word to the FLASH page */
+						boot_page_fill(PageAddress + PageByte, Endpoint_Read_Word_LE());
+					}
+
+					/* Write the filled FLASH page to memory */
+					boot_page_write(PageAddress);
+					boot_spm_busy_wait();
+
+					/* Re-enable RWW section */
+					boot_rww_enable();
+				}
+
+				Endpoint_ClearSetupOUT();
+
+				/* Wait until the host is ready to receive the request confirmation */
+				while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupINReady()));
+				
+				/* Handshake the request by sending an empty IN packet */
+				Endpoint_ClearSetupIN();
+			}
+			
+			break;
+	}
+}
diff --git a/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/TeensyHID.h b/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/TeensyHID.h
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..a53fca30f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/TeensyHID.h
@@ -0,0 +1,73 @@
+/*
+             LUFA Library
+     Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2009.
+              
+  dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+      www.fourwalledcubicle.com
+*/
+
+/*
+  Copyright 2009  Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com)
+	  
+  Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software
+  and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby
+  granted, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all
+  copies and that both that the copyright notice and this
+  permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting
+  documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in
+  advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
+  software without specific, written prior permission.
+
+  The author disclaim all warranties with regard to this
+  software, including all implied warranties of merchantability
+  and fitness.  In no event shall the author be liable for any
+  special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages
+  whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether
+  in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action,
+  arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of
+  this software.
+*/
+
+/** \file
+ *
+ *  Header file for TeensyHID.c.
+ */
+ 
+#ifndef _TEENSYHID_H_
+#define _TEENSYHID_H_
+
+	/* Includes: */
+		#include <avr/io.h>
+		#include <avr/wdt.h>
+		#include <avr/boot.h>
+		#include <avr/wdt.h>
+		#include <util/delay.h>
+		#include <stdbool.h>
+
+		#include "Descriptors.h"
+
+		#include <LUFA/Version.h>                    // Library Version Information
+		#include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h>            // USB Functionality
+		
+	/* Preprocessor Checks: */
+		#if !defined(__AVR_AT90USB162__)
+			#error This bootloader is not compatible with the selected AVR model.
+		#endif
+
+	/* Macros: */
+		/** HID Class specific request to send the next HID report to the device. */
+		#define REQ_SetReport           0x09
+		
+		#define TEENSY_STARTAPPLICATION 0xFFFF
+
+	/* Event Handlers: */
+		/** Indicates that this module will catch the USB_Disconnect event when thrown by the library. */
+		HANDLES_EVENT(USB_Disconnect);
+
+		/** Indicates that this module will catch the USB_ConfigurationChanged event when thrown by the library. */
+		HANDLES_EVENT(USB_ConfigurationChanged);
+
+		/** Indicates that this module will catch the USB_UnhandledControlPacket event when thrown by the library. */
+		HANDLES_EVENT(USB_UnhandledControlPacket);
+		
+#endif
diff --git a/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/TeensyHID.txt b/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/TeensyHID.txt
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..973819cf8
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/TeensyHID.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,41 @@
+/** \file
+ *
+ *  This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special
+ *  documentation pages. It is not a project source file.
+ */
+ 
+/** \mainpage Teensy HID Class USB AVR Bootloader
+ * 
+ * This bootloader enumerates to the host as a HID Class device, allowing for Teensy compatible programming
+ * software to load firmware onto the AVR, such as the official software at http://www.pjrc.com/teensy/.
+ *  
+ * Out of the box this bootloader builds for the USB162, and will fit into 2KB of bootloader space.
+ *
+ * This spoofs (with permission) the offical Teensy bootloader's VID and PID, so that the software remains
+ * compatible with no changes.
+ *  
+ * <table>
+ *  <tr>
+ *   <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td>
+ *   <td>Device</td>
+ *  </tr>
+ *  <tr>
+ *   <td><b>USB Class:</b></td>
+ *   <td>Human Interface Device Class (HID)</td>
+ *  </tr>
+ *  <tr> 
+ *   <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td>
+ *   <td>N/A</td>
+ *  </tr>
+ *  <tr>
+ *   <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td>
+ *   <td>USBIF HID Class Standard</td>
+ *   <td>Teensy Programming Protocol Details</td>
+ *  </tr>
+ *  <tr>
+ *   <td><b>Usable Speeds:</b></td>
+ *   <td>Low Speed Mode</td>
+ *   <td>Full Speed Mode</td>
+ *  </tr>
+ * </table>
+ */
diff --git a/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/makefile b/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/makefile
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..92dd8b9b3
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/makefile
@@ -0,0 +1,711 @@
+# Hey Emacs, this is a -*- makefile -*-
+#----------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# WinAVR Makefile Template written by Eric B. Weddington, J�rg Wunsch, et al.
+#  >> Modified for use with the LUFA project. <<
+#
+# Released to the Public Domain
+#
+# Additional material for this makefile was written by:
+# Peter Fleury
+# Tim Henigan
+# Colin O'Flynn
+# Reiner Patommel
+# Markus Pfaff
+# Sander Pool
+# Frederik Rouleau
+# Carlos Lamas
+# Dean Camera
+# Opendous Inc.
+# Denver Gingerich
+#
+#----------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# On command line:
+#
+# make all = Make software.
+#
+# make clean = Clean out built project files.
+#
+# make coff = Convert ELF to AVR COFF.
+#
+# make extcoff = Convert ELF to AVR Extended COFF.
+#
+# make program = Download the hex file to the device, using avrdude.
+#                Please customize the avrdude settings below first!
+#
+# make dfu = Download the hex file to the device, using dfu-programmer (must
+#            have dfu-programmer installed).
+#
+# make flip = Download the hex file to the device, using Atmel FLIP (must
+#             have Atmel FLIP installed).
+#
+# make dfu-ee = Download the eeprom file to the device, using dfu-programmer
+#               (must have dfu-programmer installed).
+#
+# make flip-ee = Download the eeprom file to the device, using Atmel FLIP
+#                (must have Atmel FLIP installed).
+#
+# make doxygen = Generate DoxyGen documentation for the project (must have
+#                DoxyGen installed)
+#
+# make debug = Start either simulavr or avarice as specified for debugging, 
+#              with avr-gdb or avr-insight as the front end for debugging.
+#
+# make filename.s = Just compile filename.c into the assembler code only.
+#
+# make filename.i = Create a preprocessed source file for use in submitting
+#                   bug reports to the GCC project.
+#
+# To rebuild project do "make clean" then "make all".
+#----------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+
+# MCU name
+MCU = at90usb162
+
+
+# Target board (see library BoardTypes.h documentation, USER or blank for projects not requiring
+# LUFA board drivers). If USER is selected, put custom board drivers in a directory called 
+# "Board" inside the application directory.
+BOARD  = USBKEY
+
+
+# Processor frequency.
+#     This will define a symbol, F_CPU, in all source code files equal to the 
+#     processor frequency. You can then use this symbol in your source code to 
+#     calculate timings. Do NOT tack on a 'UL' at the end, this will be done
+#     automatically to create a 32-bit value in your source code.
+#     Typical values are:
+#         F_CPU =  1000000
+#         F_CPU =  1843200
+#         F_CPU =  2000000
+#         F_CPU =  3686400
+#         F_CPU =  4000000
+#         F_CPU =  7372800
+#         F_CPU =  8000000
+#         F_CPU = 11059200
+#         F_CPU = 14745600
+#         F_CPU = 16000000
+#         F_CPU = 18432000
+#         F_CPU = 20000000
+F_CPU = 8000000
+
+
+# Output format. (can be srec, ihex, binary)
+FORMAT = ihex
+
+
+# Target file name (without extension).
+TARGET = TeensyHID
+
+
+# Object files directory
+#     To put object files in current directory, use a dot (.), do NOT make
+#     this an empty or blank macro!
+OBJDIR = .
+
+
+# List C source files here. (C dependencies are automatically generated.)
+SRC = $(TARGET).c                                          \
+	  Descriptors.c                                        \
+	  ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/LowLevel.c           \
+	  ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/Endpoint.c           \
+	  ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/DevChapter9.c        \
+	  ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/USBTask.c           \
+	  ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/USBInterrupt.c      \
+	  ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/Events.c            \
+	  ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/StdDescriptors.c    \
+	  
+# List C++ source files here. (C dependencies are automatically generated.)
+CPPSRC = 
+
+
+# List Assembler source files here.
+#     Make them always end in a capital .S.  Files ending in a lowercase .s
+#     will not be considered source files but generated files (assembler
+#     output from the compiler), and will be deleted upon "make clean"!
+#     Even though the DOS/Win* filesystem matches both .s and .S the same,
+#     it will preserve the spelling of the filenames, and gcc itself does
+#     care about how the name is spelled on its command-line.
+ASRC =
+
+
+# Optimization level, can be [0, 1, 2, 3, s]. 
+#     0 = turn off optimization. s = optimize for size.
+#     (Note: 3 is not always the best optimization level. See avr-libc FAQ.)
+OPT = s
+
+
+# Debugging format.
+#     Native formats for AVR-GCC's -g are dwarf-2 [default] or stabs.
+#     AVR Studio 4.10 requires dwarf-2.
+#     AVR [Extended] COFF format requires stabs, plus an avr-objcopy run.
+DEBUG = dwarf-2
+
+
+# List any extra directories to look for include files here.
+#     Each directory must be seperated by a space.
+#     Use forward slashes for directory separators.
+#     For a directory that has spaces, enclose it in quotes.
+EXTRAINCDIRS = ../../
+
+
+# Compiler flag to set the C Standard level.
+#     c89   = "ANSI" C
+#     gnu89 = c89 plus GCC extensions
+#     c99   = ISO C99 standard (not yet fully implemented)
+#     gnu99 = c99 plus GCC extensions
+CSTANDARD = -std=gnu99
+
+
+# Starting byte address of the bootloader
+BOOT_START = 0xC000
+
+
+# Place -D or -U options here for C sources
+CDEFS  = -DF_CPU=$(F_CPU)UL -DBOARD=BOARD_$(BOARD) -DUSE_NONSTANDARD_DESCRIPTOR_NAMES -DSTATIC_ENDPOINT_CONFIGURATION
+CDEFS += -DUSB_DEVICE_ONLY -DUSE_STATIC_OPTIONS="(USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL)"
+CDEFS += -DUSE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS -DBOOT_START_ADDR=$(BOOT_START)UL -DFIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE=8 -DUSE_SINGLE_DEVICE_CONFIGURATION
+CDEFS += -DNO_CLEARSET_FEATURE_REQUEST
+
+# Place -D or -U options here for ASM sources
+ADEFS = -DF_CPU=$(F_CPU)
+
+
+# Place -D or -U options here for C++ sources
+CPPDEFS = -DF_CPU=$(F_CPU)UL
+#CPPDEFS += -D__STDC_LIMIT_MACROS
+#CPPDEFS += -D__STDC_CONSTANT_MACROS
+
+
+
+#---------------- Compiler Options C ----------------
+#  -g*:          generate debugging information
+#  -O*:          optimization level
+#  -f...:        tuning, see GCC manual and avr-libc documentation
+#  -Wall...:     warning level
+#  -Wa,...:      tell GCC to pass this to the assembler.
+#    -adhlns...: create assembler listing
+CFLAGS = -g$(DEBUG)
+CFLAGS += $(CDEFS)
+CFLAGS += -O$(OPT)
+CFLAGS += -funsigned-char
+CFLAGS += -funsigned-bitfields
+CFLAGS += -ffunction-sections
+CFLAGS += -fpack-struct
+CFLAGS += -fshort-enums
+CFLAGS += -fno-inline-small-functions
+CFLAGS += -fno-reorder-blocks
+CFLAGS += -fno-reorder-blocks-and-partition
+CFLAGS += -fno-reorder-functions
+CFLAGS += -fno-toplevel-reorder
+CFLAGS += -Wall
+CFLAGS += -Wstrict-prototypes
+CFLAGS += -Wundef
+#CFLAGS += -fno-unit-at-a-time
+#CFLAGS += -Wunreachable-code
+#CFLAGS += -Wsign-compare
+CFLAGS += -Wa,-adhlns=$(<:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst)
+CFLAGS += $(patsubst %,-I%,$(EXTRAINCDIRS))
+CFLAGS += $(CSTANDARD)
+
+
+#---------------- Compiler Options C++ ----------------
+#  -g*:          generate debugging information
+#  -O*:          optimization level
+#  -f...:        tuning, see GCC manual and avr-libc documentation
+#  -Wall...:     warning level
+#  -Wa,...:      tell GCC to pass this to the assembler.
+#    -adhlns...: create assembler listing
+CPPFLAGS = -g$(DEBUG)
+CPPFLAGS += $(CPPDEFS)
+CPPFLAGS += -O$(OPT)
+CPPFLAGS += -funsigned-char
+CPPFLAGS += -funsigned-bitfields
+CPPFLAGS += -fpack-struct
+CPPFLAGS += -fshort-enums
+CPPFLAGS += -fno-exceptions
+CPPFLAGS += -Wall
+CFLAGS += -Wundef
+#CPPFLAGS += -mshort-calls
+#CPPFLAGS += -fno-unit-at-a-time
+#CPPFLAGS += -Wstrict-prototypes
+#CPPFLAGS += -Wunreachable-code
+#CPPFLAGS += -Wsign-compare
+CPPFLAGS += -Wa,-adhlns=$(<:%.cpp=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst)
+CPPFLAGS += $(patsubst %,-I%,$(EXTRAINCDIRS))
+#CPPFLAGS += $(CSTANDARD)
+
+
+#---------------- Assembler Options ----------------
+#  -Wa,...:   tell GCC to pass this to the assembler.
+#  -adhlns:   create listing
+#  -gstabs:   have the assembler create line number information; note that
+#             for use in COFF files, additional information about filenames
+#             and function names needs to be present in the assembler source
+#             files -- see avr-libc docs [FIXME: not yet described there]
+#  -listing-cont-lines: Sets the maximum number of continuation lines of hex 
+#       dump that will be displayed for a given single line of source input.
+ASFLAGS = $(ADEFS) -Wa,-adhlns=$(<:%.S=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst),-gstabs,--listing-cont-lines=100
+
+
+#---------------- Library Options ----------------
+# Minimalistic printf version
+PRINTF_LIB_MIN = -Wl,-u,vfprintf -lprintf_min
+
+# Floating point printf version (requires MATH_LIB = -lm below)
+PRINTF_LIB_FLOAT = -Wl,-u,vfprintf -lprintf_flt
+
+# If this is left blank, then it will use the Standard printf version.
+PRINTF_LIB = 
+#PRINTF_LIB = $(PRINTF_LIB_MIN)
+#PRINTF_LIB = $(PRINTF_LIB_FLOAT)
+
+
+# Minimalistic scanf version
+SCANF_LIB_MIN = -Wl,-u,vfscanf -lscanf_min
+
+# Floating point + %[ scanf version (requires MATH_LIB = -lm below)
+SCANF_LIB_FLOAT = -Wl,-u,vfscanf -lscanf_flt
+
+# If this is left blank, then it will use the Standard scanf version.
+SCANF_LIB = 
+#SCANF_LIB = $(SCANF_LIB_MIN)
+#SCANF_LIB = $(SCANF_LIB_FLOAT)
+
+
+MATH_LIB = -lm
+
+
+# List any extra directories to look for libraries here.
+#     Each directory must be seperated by a space.
+#     Use forward slashes for directory separators.
+#     For a directory that has spaces, enclose it in quotes.
+EXTRALIBDIRS = 
+
+
+
+#---------------- External Memory Options ----------------
+
+# 64 KB of external RAM, starting after internal RAM (ATmega128!),
+# used for variables (.data/.bss) and heap (malloc()).
+#EXTMEMOPTS = -Wl,-Tdata=0x801100,--defsym=__heap_end=0x80ffff
+
+# 64 KB of external RAM, starting after internal RAM (ATmega128!),
+# only used for heap (malloc()).
+#EXTMEMOPTS = -Wl,--section-start,.data=0x801100,--defsym=__heap_end=0x80ffff
+
+EXTMEMOPTS =
+
+
+
+#---------------- Linker Options ----------------
+#  -Wl,...:     tell GCC to pass this to linker.
+#    -Map:      create map file
+#    --cref:    add cross reference to  map file
+LDFLAGS = -Wl,-Map=$(TARGET).map,--cref
+LDFLAGS += -Wl,--relax 
+LDFLAGS += -Wl,--gc-sections
+LDFLAGS += -Wl,--section-start=.text=$(BOOT_START)
+LDFLAGS += $(EXTMEMOPTS)
+LDFLAGS += $(patsubst %,-L%,$(EXTRALIBDIRS))
+LDFLAGS += $(PRINTF_LIB) $(SCANF_LIB) $(MATH_LIB)
+#LDFLAGS += -T linker_script.x
+
+
+
+#---------------- Programming Options (avrdude) ----------------
+
+# Programming hardware: alf avr910 avrisp bascom bsd 
+# dt006 pavr picoweb pony-stk200 sp12 stk200 stk500
+#
+# Type: avrdude -c ?
+# to get a full listing.
+#
+AVRDUDE_PROGRAMMER = jtagmkII
+
+# com1 = serial port. Use lpt1 to connect to parallel port.
+AVRDUDE_PORT = usb
+
+AVRDUDE_WRITE_FLASH = -U flash:w:$(TARGET).hex
+#AVRDUDE_WRITE_EEPROM = -U eeprom:w:$(TARGET).eep
+
+
+# Uncomment the following if you want avrdude's erase cycle counter.
+# Note that this counter needs to be initialized first using -Yn,
+# see avrdude manual.
+#AVRDUDE_ERASE_COUNTER = -y
+
+# Uncomment the following if you do /not/ wish a verification to be
+# performed after programming the device.
+#AVRDUDE_NO_VERIFY = -V
+
+# Increase verbosity level.  Please use this when submitting bug
+# reports about avrdude. See <http://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/avrdude> 
+# to submit bug reports.
+#AVRDUDE_VERBOSE = -v -v
+
+AVRDUDE_FLAGS = -p $(MCU) -P $(AVRDUDE_PORT) -c $(AVRDUDE_PROGRAMMER)
+AVRDUDE_FLAGS += $(AVRDUDE_NO_VERIFY)
+AVRDUDE_FLAGS += $(AVRDUDE_VERBOSE)
+AVRDUDE_FLAGS += $(AVRDUDE_ERASE_COUNTER)
+
+
+
+#---------------- Debugging Options ----------------
+
+# For simulavr only - target MCU frequency.
+DEBUG_MFREQ = $(F_CPU)
+
+# Set the DEBUG_UI to either gdb or insight.
+# DEBUG_UI = gdb
+DEBUG_UI = insight
+
+# Set the debugging back-end to either avarice, simulavr.
+DEBUG_BACKEND = avarice
+#DEBUG_BACKEND = simulavr
+
+# GDB Init Filename.
+GDBINIT_FILE = __avr_gdbinit
+
+# When using avarice settings for the JTAG
+JTAG_DEV = /dev/com1
+
+# Debugging port used to communicate between GDB / avarice / simulavr.
+DEBUG_PORT = 4242
+
+# Debugging host used to communicate between GDB / avarice / simulavr, normally
+#     just set to localhost unless doing some sort of crazy debugging when 
+#     avarice is running on a different computer.
+DEBUG_HOST = localhost
+
+
+
+#============================================================================
+
+
+# Define programs and commands.
+SHELL = sh
+CC = avr-gcc
+OBJCOPY = avr-objcopy
+OBJDUMP = avr-objdump
+SIZE = avr-size
+AR = avr-ar rcs
+NM = avr-nm
+AVRDUDE = avrdude
+REMOVE = rm -f
+REMOVEDIR = rm -rf
+COPY = cp
+WINSHELL = cmd
+
+# Define Messages
+# English
+MSG_ERRORS_NONE = Errors: none
+MSG_BEGIN = -------- begin --------
+MSG_END = --------  end  --------
+MSG_SIZE_BEFORE = Size before: 
+MSG_SIZE_AFTER = Size after:
+MSG_COFF = Converting to AVR COFF:
+MSG_EXTENDED_COFF = Converting to AVR Extended COFF:
+MSG_FLASH = Creating load file for Flash:
+MSG_EEPROM = Creating load file for EEPROM:
+MSG_EXTENDED_LISTING = Creating Extended Listing:
+MSG_SYMBOL_TABLE = Creating Symbol Table:
+MSG_LINKING = Linking:
+MSG_COMPILING = Compiling C:
+MSG_COMPILING_CPP = Compiling C++:
+MSG_ASSEMBLING = Assembling:
+MSG_CLEANING = Cleaning project:
+MSG_CREATING_LIBRARY = Creating library:
+
+
+
+
+# Define all object files.
+OBJ = $(SRC:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.o) $(CPPSRC:%.cpp=$(OBJDIR)/%.o) $(ASRC:%.S=$(OBJDIR)/%.o) 
+
+# Define all listing files.
+LST = $(SRC:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst) $(CPPSRC:%.cpp=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst) $(ASRC:%.S=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst) 
+
+
+# Compiler flags to generate dependency files.
+GENDEPFLAGS = -MMD -MP -MF .dep/$(@F).d
+
+
+# Combine all necessary flags and optional flags.
+# Add target processor to flags.
+ALL_CFLAGS = -mmcu=$(MCU) -I. $(CFLAGS) $(GENDEPFLAGS)
+ALL_CPPFLAGS = -mmcu=$(MCU) -I. -x c++ $(CPPFLAGS) $(GENDEPFLAGS)
+ALL_ASFLAGS = -mmcu=$(MCU) -I. -x assembler-with-cpp $(ASFLAGS)
+
+
+
+
+
+# Default target.
+all: begin gccversion sizebefore build checkhooks checklibmode sizeafter end
+
+# Change the build target to build a HEX file or a library.
+build: elf hex eep lss sym
+#build: lib
+
+
+elf: $(TARGET).elf
+hex: $(TARGET).hex
+eep: $(TARGET).eep
+lss: $(TARGET).lss
+sym: $(TARGET).sym
+LIBNAME=lib$(TARGET).a
+lib: $(LIBNAME)
+
+
+
+# Eye candy.
+# AVR Studio 3.x does not check make's exit code but relies on
+# the following magic strings to be generated by the compile job.
+begin:
+	@echo
+	@echo $(MSG_BEGIN)
+
+end:
+	@echo $(MSG_END)
+	@echo
+
+
+# Display size of file.
+HEXSIZE = $(SIZE) --target=$(FORMAT) $(TARGET).hex
+ELFSIZE = $(SIZE) $(MCU_FLAG) $(FORMAT_FLAG) $(TARGET).elf
+MCU_FLAG = $(shell $(SIZE) --help | grep -- --mcu > /dev/null && echo --mcu=$(MCU) )
+FORMAT_FLAG = $(shell $(SIZE) --help | grep -- --format=.*avr > /dev/null && echo --format=avr )
+
+sizebefore:
+	@if test -f $(TARGET).elf; then echo; echo $(MSG_SIZE_BEFORE); $(ELFSIZE); \
+	2>/dev/null; echo; fi
+
+sizeafter:
+	@if test -f $(TARGET).elf; then echo; echo $(MSG_SIZE_AFTER); $(ELFSIZE); \
+	2>/dev/null; echo; fi
+
+checkhooks: build
+	@echo
+	@echo ------- Unhooked LUFA Events -------
+	@$(shell) (grep -s '^Event.*LUFA/.*\\.o' $(TARGET).map | \
+	           cut -d' ' -f1 | cut -d'_' -f2- | grep ".*") || \
+			   echo "(None)"
+	@echo ----- End Unhooked LUFA Events -----
+
+checklibmode:
+	@echo
+	@echo ----------- Library Mode -----------
+	@$(shell) ($(CC) $(ALL_CFLAGS) -E -dM - < /dev/null \
+	          | grep 'USB_\(DEVICE\|HOST\)_ONLY' | cut -d' ' -f2 | grep ".*") \
+	          || echo "No specific mode (both device and host mode allowable)."
+	@echo ------------------------------------
+
+# Display compiler version information.
+gccversion : 
+	@$(CC) --version
+
+
+
+# Program the device.  
+program: $(TARGET).hex $(TARGET).eep
+	$(AVRDUDE) $(AVRDUDE_FLAGS) $(AVRDUDE_WRITE_FLASH) $(AVRDUDE_WRITE_EEPROM)
+
+flip: $(TARGET).hex
+	batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation erase f
+	batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation loadbuffer $(TARGET).hex program
+	batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation start reset 0
+
+dfu: $(TARGET).hex
+	dfu-programmer $(MCU) erase
+	dfu-programmer $(MCU) flash --debug 1 $(TARGET).hex
+	dfu-programmer $(MCU) reset
+
+flip-ee: $(TARGET).hex $(TARGET).eep
+	copy $(TARGET).eep $(TARGET)eep.hex
+	batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation memory EEPROM erase
+	batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation memory EEPROM loadbuffer $(TARGET)eep.hex program
+	batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation start reset 0
+
+dfu-ee: $(TARGET).hex $(TARGET).eep
+	dfu-programmer $(MCU) erase
+	dfu-programmer $(MCU) eeprom --debug 1 $(TARGET).eep
+	dfu-programmer $(MCU) reset
+
+# Generate avr-gdb config/init file which does the following:
+#     define the reset signal, load the target file, connect to target, and set 
+#     a breakpoint at main().
+gdb-config: 
+	@$(REMOVE) $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+	@echo define reset >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+	@echo SIGNAL SIGHUP >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+	@echo end >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+	@echo file $(TARGET).elf >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+	@echo target remote $(DEBUG_HOST):$(DEBUG_PORT)  >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+ifeq ($(DEBUG_BACKEND),simulavr)
+	@echo load  >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+endif
+	@echo break main >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+
+debug: gdb-config $(TARGET).elf
+ifeq ($(DEBUG_BACKEND), avarice)
+	@echo Starting AVaRICE - Press enter when "waiting to connect" message displays.
+	@$(WINSHELL) /c start avarice --jtag $(JTAG_DEV) --erase --program --file \
+	$(TARGET).elf $(DEBUG_HOST):$(DEBUG_PORT)
+	@$(WINSHELL) /c pause
+
+else
+	@$(WINSHELL) /c start simulavr --gdbserver --device $(MCU) --clock-freq \
+	$(DEBUG_MFREQ) --port $(DEBUG_PORT)
+endif
+	@$(WINSHELL) /c start avr-$(DEBUG_UI) --command=$(GDBINIT_FILE)
+
+
+
+
+# Convert ELF to COFF for use in debugging / simulating in AVR Studio or VMLAB.
+COFFCONVERT = $(OBJCOPY) --debugging
+COFFCONVERT += --change-section-address .data-0x800000
+COFFCONVERT += --change-section-address .bss-0x800000
+COFFCONVERT += --change-section-address .noinit-0x800000
+COFFCONVERT += --change-section-address .eeprom-0x810000
+
+
+
+coff: $(TARGET).elf
+	@echo
+	@echo $(MSG_COFF) $(TARGET).cof
+	$(COFFCONVERT) -O coff-avr $< $(TARGET).cof
+
+
+extcoff: $(TARGET).elf
+	@echo
+	@echo $(MSG_EXTENDED_COFF) $(TARGET).cof
+	$(COFFCONVERT) -O coff-ext-avr $< $(TARGET).cof
+
+
+
+# Create final output files (.hex, .eep) from ELF output file.
+%.hex: %.elf
+	@echo
+	@echo $(MSG_FLASH) $@
+	$(OBJCOPY) -O $(FORMAT) -R .eeprom $< $@
+
+%.eep: %.elf
+	@echo
+	@echo $(MSG_EEPROM) $@
+	-$(OBJCOPY) -j .eeprom --set-section-flags=.eeprom="alloc,load" \
+	--change-section-lma .eeprom=0 --no-change-warnings -O $(FORMAT) $< $@ || exit 0
+
+# Create extended listing file from ELF output file.
+%.lss: %.elf
+	@echo
+	@echo $(MSG_EXTENDED_LISTING) $@
+	$(OBJDUMP) -h -z -S $< > $@
+
+# Create a symbol table from ELF output file.
+%.sym: %.elf
+	@echo
+	@echo $(MSG_SYMBOL_TABLE) $@
+	$(NM) -n $< > $@
+
+
+
+# Create library from object files.
+.SECONDARY : $(TARGET).a
+.PRECIOUS : $(OBJ)
+%.a: $(OBJ)
+	@echo
+	@echo $(MSG_CREATING_LIBRARY) $@
+	$(AR) $@ $(OBJ)
+
+
+# Link: create ELF output file from object files.
+.SECONDARY : $(TARGET).elf
+.PRECIOUS : $(OBJ)
+%.elf: $(OBJ)
+	@echo
+	@echo $(MSG_LINKING) $@
+	$(CC) $(ALL_CFLAGS) $^ --output $@ $(LDFLAGS)
+
+
+# Compile: create object files from C source files.
+$(OBJDIR)/%.o : %.c
+	@echo
+	@echo $(MSG_COMPILING) $<
+	$(CC) -c $(ALL_CFLAGS) $< -o $@ 
+
+
+# Compile: create object files from C++ source files.
+$(OBJDIR)/%.o : %.cpp
+	@echo
+	@echo $(MSG_COMPILING_CPP) $<
+	$(CC) -c $(ALL_CPPFLAGS) $< -o $@ 
+
+
+# Compile: create assembler files from C source files.
+%.s : %.c
+	$(CC) -S $(ALL_CFLAGS) $< -o $@
+
+
+# Compile: create assembler files from C++ source files.
+%.s : %.cpp
+	$(CC) -S $(ALL_CPPFLAGS) $< -o $@
+
+
+# Assemble: create object files from assembler source files.
+$(OBJDIR)/%.o : %.S
+	@echo
+	@echo $(MSG_ASSEMBLING) $<
+	$(CC) -c $(ALL_ASFLAGS) $< -o $@
+
+
+# Create preprocessed source for use in sending a bug report.
+%.i : %.c
+	$(CC) -E -mmcu=$(MCU) -I. $(CFLAGS) $< -o $@ 
+	
+
+# Target: clean project.
+clean: begin clean_list clean_binary end
+
+clean_binary:
+	$(REMOVE) $(TARGET).hex
+
+clean_list:
+	@echo $(MSG_CLEANING)
+	$(REMOVE) $(TARGET).eep
+	$(REMOVE) $(TARGET).cof
+	$(REMOVE) $(TARGET).elf
+	$(REMOVE) $(TARGET).map
+	$(REMOVE) $(TARGET).sym
+	$(REMOVE) $(TARGET).lss
+	$(REMOVE) $(SRC:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.o)
+	$(REMOVE) $(SRC:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst)
+	$(REMOVE) $(SRC:.c=.s)
+	$(REMOVE) $(SRC:.c=.d)
+	$(REMOVE) $(SRC:.c=.i)
+	$(REMOVEDIR) .dep
+
+
+doxygen:
+	@echo Generating Project Documentation...
+	@doxygen Doxygen.conf
+	@echo Documentation Generation Complete.
+
+clean_doxygen:
+	rm -rf Documentation
+
+# Create object files directory
+$(shell mkdir $(OBJDIR) 2>/dev/null)
+
+
+# Include the dependency files.
+-include $(shell mkdir .dep 2>/dev/null) $(wildcard .dep/*)
+
+
+# Listing of phony targets.
+.PHONY : all checkhooks checklibmode begin  \
+finish end sizebefore sizeafter gccversion  \
+build elf hex eep lss sym coff extcoff      \
+clean clean_list clean_binary program debug \
+gdb-config doxygen
diff --git a/Bootloaders/makefile b/Bootloaders/makefile
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..78af34d67
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Bootloaders/makefile
@@ -0,0 +1,29 @@
+#
+#             LUFA Library
+#     Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2009.
+#              
+#  dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+#      www.fourwalledcubicle.com
+#
+
+# Makefile to build all the LUFA USB Bootloaders. Call with "make all" to
+# rebuild all bootloaders.
+
+# Bootloaders are pre-cleaned before each one is built, to ensure any
+# custom LUFA library build options are reflected in the compiled
+# code.
+
+all:
+	make -C 'DFU/' clean
+	make -C 'DFU/' all
+
+	make -C 'CDC/' clean
+	make -C 'CDC/' all
+
+	make -C 'TeensyHID/' clean
+	make -C 'TeensyHID/' all
+
+%:
+	make -C 'DFU/' $@
+	make -C 'CDC/' $@
+	make -C 'TeensyHID/' $@
-- 
GitLab